blob: ee3596bde433d83a9805117befff6c17acbc6264 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000039#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000040#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000041#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000042#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000043#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000044#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
45#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
46#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000047#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000048#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000049#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000050#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000051#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000052#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000053#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000054#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000055#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000056#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000057#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000060#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000061#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000062#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000063using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000064using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000065
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000066STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
67STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
68STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
69STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
70STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000071
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000072namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000073 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
74 : public FunctionPass,
75 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000076 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000077 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000078 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000079 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000080 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000082 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000083 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000084
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000085 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
86 /// isn't already in it.
87 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000088 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000089 Worklist.push_back(I);
90 }
91
92 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
93 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
94 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
95 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
96
97 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
98 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
99
100 WorklistMap.erase(It);
101 }
102
103 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
104 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
105 Worklist.pop_back();
106 WorklistMap.erase(I);
107 return I;
108 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000109
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000110
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000111 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
112 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
113 /// now.
114 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000115 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000116 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000117 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000118 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000119 }
120
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000121 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
122 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
123 ///
124 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000125 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
126 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000127 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000128 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000129
130 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
131 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
132 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
133 ///
134 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
135 ///
136 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
137 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
138
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000139 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
140 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000141 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000142 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000143 *i = UndefValue::get(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000144 }
145
146 return R;
147 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000148
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000149 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000150 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000151
152 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000153
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000154 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000155 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000156 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000157 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000158 }
159
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000160 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
161
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000162 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
163 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
164 // Return Value:
165 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000166 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000168 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000169 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
170 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
171 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000172 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
173 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
174 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000175 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000176 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
177 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000178 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
179 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
180 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +0000183 Instruction *FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000184 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +0000185 Instruction *FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +0000186 Instruction *FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +0000187 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000188 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000190 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
191 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
192 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
193 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000194 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
195 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000196 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
197 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
198 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000199 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
200 Instruction *LHS,
201 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000202 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
203 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000204
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000205 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
206 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000207 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000208 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000209 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
210 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000211 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000212 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
213 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
214 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000215 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000216 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000217 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
218 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000219 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
220 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
221 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000222 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000223 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000224 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
225 Instruction *FI);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000226 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
227 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000228 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
229 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000230 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
231 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000232 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000233 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000234 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000235 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000236 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000237 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000238 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000239 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000240 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000241 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000242
243 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000244 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000245
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000246 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000247 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000248 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000249 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000250 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
251 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000252 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000253
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000254 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000255 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
256 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
257 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000258 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000259 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
260 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000261 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
262 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000263 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000264 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000265 }
266
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000267 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
268 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
269 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000270 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
271 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000272 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000273
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000274 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000275 return ConstantExpr::getCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000276
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000277 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000278 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000279 return C;
280 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000281
282 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
283 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
284 }
285
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000286
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000287 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
288 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
289 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
290 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
291 // modified.
292 //
293 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000294 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000295 if (&I != V) {
296 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
297 return &I;
298 } else {
299 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
300 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +0000301 I.replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000302 return &I;
303 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000304 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000305
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000306 // UpdateValueUsesWith - This method is to be used when an value is
307 // found to be replacable with another preexisting expression or was
308 // updated. Here we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of
309 // I with the new value (unless the instruction was just updated), then
310 // return true, so that the inst combiner will know that I was modified.
311 //
312 bool UpdateValueUsesWith(Value *Old, Value *New) {
313 AddUsersToWorkList(*Old); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
314 if (Old != New)
315 Old->replaceAllUsesWith(New);
316 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Old))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000317 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +0000318 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(New))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000319 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000320 return true;
321 }
322
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000323 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
324 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
325 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
326 // this function.
327 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
328 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
329 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000330 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000331 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000332 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
333 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000334
335 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
336 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
337 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
338 }
339
340 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
341 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
342 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
343 }
344 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
345 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
346 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000347
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000348 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000349
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000350 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
351 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000352 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000353
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000354 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
355 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
356 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
357
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +0000358 /// SimplifyDemandedBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value based
359 /// on the demanded bits.
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000360 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
361 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
362 unsigned Depth = 0);
363
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000364 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
365 uint64_t &UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
366
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000367 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
368 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
369 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
370 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
371
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000372 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
373 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
374 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
375 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000376 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +0000377 Instruction *FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
378
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000379
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000380 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
381 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000382
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000383 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000384 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000385 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000386 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000387 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000388 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000389 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000390 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000391 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000393
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000394 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000395
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000396 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
397 unsigned CastOpc,
398 int &NumCastsRemoved);
399 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
400 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000401
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000402 };
403}
404
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000405char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
406static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
407X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
408
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000409// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000410// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000411static unsigned getComplexity(Value *V) {
412 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
413 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) || BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000414 return 3;
415 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000416 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000417 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
418 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000419}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000420
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000421// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
422// it.
423static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000424 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000425}
426
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000427// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
428// though a va_arg area...
429static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000430 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
431 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
432 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000433 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000434 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000435}
436
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000437/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
438/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
439/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000440static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
441 if (BitCastInst *I = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(V))
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000442 // BitCastInst?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000443 return I->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000444 else if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) {
445 // GetElementPtrInst?
446 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
447 return GEP->getOperand(0);
448 } else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000449 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000450 // BitCast ConstantExp?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000451 return CE->getOperand(0);
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000452 else if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
453 // GetElementPtr ConstantExp?
454 for (User::op_iterator I = CE->op_begin() + 1, E = CE->op_end();
455 I != E; ++I) {
456 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I);
457 if (!CI || !CI->isZero())
458 // Any non-zero indices? Not cast-like.
459 return 0;
460 }
461 // All-zero indices? This is just like casting.
462 return CE->getOperand(0);
463 }
464 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000465 return 0;
466}
467
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000468/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
469/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000470static Instruction::CastOps
471isEliminableCastPair(
472 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
473 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
474 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
475 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
476) {
477
478 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
479 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000480
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000481 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
482 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
483 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000484
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000485 return Instruction::CastOps(
486 CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
487 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType()));
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000488}
489
490/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
491/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
492/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000493static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
494 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000495 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
496
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000497 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000498 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000499 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000500 return false;
501 return true;
502}
503
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000504// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
505// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000506//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000507// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
508// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
509// binary operators.
510//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000511// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
512// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000513//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000514bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000515 bool Changed = false;
516 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
517 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000518
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000519 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
520 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000521 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
522 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
523 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000524 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
525 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
526 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000527 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
528 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
529 return true;
530 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
531 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
532 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
533 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
534 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
535
536 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000537 Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000538 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000539 Op1->getOperand(0),
540 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000541 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000542 I.setOperand(0, New);
543 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
544 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000545 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000546 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000547 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000548}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000549
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000550/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
551/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
552/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
553bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
554 if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) >= getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
555 return false;
556 I.swapOperands();
557 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
558 return true;
559}
560
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000561// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
562// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000563//
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000564static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) {
565 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000566 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000567
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000568 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
569 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
570 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000571
572 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
573 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
574 return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
575
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000576 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000577}
578
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000579static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
580 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000581 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000582
583 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000584 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000585 return ConstantInt::get(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000586 return 0;
587}
588
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000589// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
590// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000591// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
592// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000593//
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000594static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000595 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000596 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000597 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000598 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000599 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000600 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000601 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000602 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000603 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000604 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000605 CST = ConstantInt::get(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000606 return I->getOperand(0);
607 }
608 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000609 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000610}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000611
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000612/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
613/// expression, return it.
614static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
615 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
616 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
617 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
618 return cast<User>(V);
619 return false;
620}
621
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000622/// getOpcode - If this is an Instruction or a ConstantExpr, return the
623/// opcode value. Otherwise return UserOp1.
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000624static unsigned getOpcode(const Value *V) {
625 if (const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000626 return I->getOpcode();
Dan Gohmanb99e2e22008-05-29 19:53:46 +0000627 if (const ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000628 return CE->getOpcode();
629 // Use UserOp1 to mean there's no opcode.
630 return Instruction::UserOp1;
631}
632
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000633/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000634static ConstantInt *AddOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000635 APInt Val(C->getValue());
636 return ConstantInt::get(++Val);
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000637}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000638/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000639static ConstantInt *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
Reid Spencer2149a9d2007-03-25 19:55:33 +0000640 APInt Val(C->getValue());
641 return ConstantInt::get(--Val);
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000642}
643/// Add - Add two ConstantInts together
644static ConstantInt *Add(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
645 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() + C2->getValue());
646}
647/// And - Bitwise AND two ConstantInts together
648static ConstantInt *And(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
649 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & C2->getValue());
650}
651/// Subtract - Subtract one ConstantInt from another
652static ConstantInt *Subtract(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
653 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() - C2->getValue());
654}
655/// Multiply - Multiply two ConstantInts together
656static ConstantInt *Multiply(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2) {
657 return ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() * C2->getValue());
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000658}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000659/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
660/// this size.
661static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
662 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
663 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
664 if (sign) {
665 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
666 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
667 } else {
668 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
669 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
670 }
671
672 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
673
674 if (sign) {
675 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
676 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
677 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
678 } else
679 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
680}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000681
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000682
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000683/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
684/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
685/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
686/// constant and return true.
687static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000688 APInt Demanded) {
689 assert(I && "No instruction?");
690 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
691
692 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
693 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
694 if (!OpC) return false;
695
696 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
697 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
698 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
699 return false;
700
701 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
702 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
703 I->setOperand(OpNo, ConstantInt::get(Demanded));
704 return true;
705}
706
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000707// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
708// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
709// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
710// min/max.
711static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000712 const APInt& KnownZero,
713 const APInt& KnownOne,
714 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
715 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
716 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
717 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
718 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
719 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000720 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000721
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000722 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
723 // bit if it is unknown.
724 Min = KnownOne;
725 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
726
Zhou Sheng4acf1552007-03-28 05:15:57 +0000727 if (UnknownBits[BitWidth-1]) { // Sign bit is unknown
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +0000728 Min.set(BitWidth-1);
729 Max.clear(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000730 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000731}
732
733// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
734// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
735// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
736// min/max.
737static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000738 const APInt &KnownZero,
739 const APInt &KnownOne,
740 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
741 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth(); BitWidth = BitWidth;
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000742 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
743 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
744 Min.getBitWidth() == BitWidth && Max.getBitWidth() &&
745 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000746 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000747
748 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
749 Min = KnownOne;
750 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
751 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
752}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000753
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000754/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
755/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
756/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
757/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
758/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
759/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
760/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
761/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
762/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
763/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
764/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
765/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
766/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
767/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
768/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
769bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
770 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
771 unsigned Depth) {
772 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
773 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
774 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
775 const IntegerType *VTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
776 assert(VTy->getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
777 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
778 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
779 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne \
780 must have same BitWidth");
781 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
782 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
783 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
784 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
785 return false;
786 }
787
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000788 KnownZero.clear();
789 KnownOne.clear();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000790 if (!V->hasOneUse()) { // Other users may use these bits.
791 if (Depth != 0) { // Not at the root.
792 // Just compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
793 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
794 return false;
795 }
796 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
797 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits.
798 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
799 } else if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
800 if (V != UndefValue::get(VTy))
801 return UpdateValueUsesWith(V, UndefValue::get(VTy));
802 return false;
803 } else if (Depth == 6) { // Limit search depth.
804 return false;
805 }
806
807 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
808 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
809
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000810 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
811 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
812 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000813 default:
814 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
815 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000816 case Instruction::And:
817 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
818 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
819 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
820 return true;
821 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
822 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
823
824 // If something is known zero on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
825 // LHS.
826 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
827 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
828 return true;
829 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
830 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
831
832 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
833 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
834 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
835 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
836 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
837 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
838 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
839 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
840
841 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
842 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
843 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(VTy));
844
845 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
846 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
847 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
848
849 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
850 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
851 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
852 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
853 break;
854 case Instruction::Or:
855 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
856 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
857 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
858 return true;
859 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
860 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
861 // If something is known one on the RHS, the bits aren't demanded on the
862 // LHS.
863 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
864 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
865 return true;
866 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
867 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
868
869 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
870 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
871 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
872 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
873 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
874 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
875 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
876 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
877
878 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
879 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
880 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
881 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
882 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
883 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
884 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
885 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
886
887 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
888 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
889 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
890
891 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
892 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
893 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
894 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
895 break;
896 case Instruction::Xor: {
897 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
898 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
899 return true;
900 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
901 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
902 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
903 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
904 return true;
905 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
906 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
907
908 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
909 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
910 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
911 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
912 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
913 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(1));
914
915 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
916 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
917 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
918 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
919 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
920 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
921
922 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
923 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
924 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
925 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
926 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000927 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000928 I->getName());
929 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
930 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
931 }
932
933 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
934 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
935 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
936 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
937 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
938 // all known
939 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
940 Constant *AndC = ConstantInt::get(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
941 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000942 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000943 InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
944 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, And);
945 }
946 }
947
948 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
949 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
950 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
951 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
952
953 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
954 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
955 break;
956 }
957 case Instruction::Select:
958 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(2), DemandedMask,
959 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
960 return true;
961 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
962 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
963 return true;
964 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
965 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
966 assert((LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
967 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
968
969 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
970 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask))
971 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
972 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask))
973 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
974
975 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
976 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
977 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
978 break;
979 case Instruction::Trunc: {
980 uint32_t truncBf =
981 cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +0000982 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
983 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
984 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
985 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
986 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000987 return true;
988 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
989 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
990 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
991 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
992 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
993 break;
994 }
995 case Instruction::BitCast:
996 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isInteger())
997 return false;
998
999 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1000 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1001 return true;
1002 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1003 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1004 break;
1005 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1006 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1007 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001008 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001009
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001010 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1011 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1012 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001013 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask,
1014 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001015 return true;
1016 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1017 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1018 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1019 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1020 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1021 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001022 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001023 break;
1024 }
1025 case Instruction::SExt: {
1026 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
1027 const IntegerType *SrcTy = cast<IntegerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +00001028 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = SrcTy->getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001029
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001030 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001031 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001032
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001033 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001034 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1035 // bit is demanded.
1036 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001037 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001038
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001039 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1040 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1041 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001042 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedBits,
1043 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001044 return true;
1045 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1046 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1047 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
1048 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1049 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1050
1051 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1052 // top bits of the result.
1053
1054 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1055 // convert this into a zero extension.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001056 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits)
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001057 {
1058 // Convert to ZExt cast
1059 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName(), I);
1060 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewCast);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001061 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001062 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001063 }
1064 break;
1065 }
1066 case Instruction::Add: {
1067 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1068 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1069 // either.
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00001070 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001071
1072 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1073 // we can do.
1074 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1075 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1076 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1077 if (RHS->isZero())
1078 break;
1079
1080 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1081 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001082 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001083
1084 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
1085 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), InDemandedBits,
1086 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1087 return true;
1088
1089 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1090 // the constant.
1091 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits))
1092 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I);
1093
1094 // Avoid excess work.
1095 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1096 break;
1097
1098 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1099 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1100 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001101 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001102 I->getName());
1103 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
1104 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, Or);
1105 }
1106
1107 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1108 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1109 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1110 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1111 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1112
1113 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1114 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1115 // this scan.
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001116 const APInt& RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
1117 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001118
1119 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1120
1121 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1122 // other, and there is no input carry.
1123 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1124 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1125
1126 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1127 // is no input carry.
1128 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1129 } else {
1130 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1131 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001132 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001133 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1134 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001135 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001136 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1137 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1138 return true;
1139 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1140 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1141 return true;
1142 }
1143 }
1144 break;
1145 }
1146 case Instruction::Sub:
1147 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1148 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001149 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001150 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1151 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001152 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001153 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001154 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedFromOps,
1155 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1156 return true;
1157 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedFromOps,
1158 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1159 return true;
1160 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001161 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1162 // the known zeros and ones.
1163 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001164 break;
1165 case Instruction::Shl:
1166 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001167 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001168 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
1169 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001170 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1171 return true;
1172 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1173 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1174 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1175 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1176 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001177 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001178 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001179 }
1180 break;
1181 case Instruction::LShr:
1182 // For a logical shift right
1183 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001184 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001185
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001186 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001187 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
1188 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001189 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1190 return true;
1191 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1192 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001193 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1194 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001195 if (ShiftAmt) {
1196 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001197 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001198 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1199 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001200 }
1201 break;
1202 case Instruction::AShr:
1203 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1204 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1205 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1206 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1207 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1208 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001209 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001210 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
1211 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1212 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1213 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001214
1215 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1216 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1217 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
1218 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001219
1220 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001221 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001222
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001223 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001224 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001225 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1226 // demanded.
1227 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1228 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001229 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001230 DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001231 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1232 return true;
1233 assert((RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) == 0 &&
1234 "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1235 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001236 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001237 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1238 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1239
1240 // Handle the sign bits.
1241 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1242 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1243 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1244
1245 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1246 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001247 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001248 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1249 // Perform the logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001250 Value *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001251 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
1252 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NewVal), *I);
1253 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1254 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1255 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1256 }
1257 }
1258 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001259 case Instruction::SRem:
1260 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001261 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1262 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001263 if (DemandedMask.ule(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
1264 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, I->getOperand(0));
1265
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001266 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001267 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
1268 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), Mask2,
1269 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
1270 return true;
1271
1272 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1273 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001274
1275 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001276
1277 assert((KnownZero & KnownOne) == 0&&"Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1278 }
1279 }
1280 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001281 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001282 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1283 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001284 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(0), AllOnes,
1285 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1286 return true;
1287
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001288 uint32_t Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001289 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperand(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001290 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
1291 return true;
1292
1293 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1294 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1295 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001296 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001297 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001298 case Instruction::Call:
1299 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1300 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1301 default: break;
1302 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1303 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1304 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1305 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1306 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1307
1308 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1309 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1310 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1311 NLZ &= ~7;
1312 NTZ &= ~7;
1313 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1314 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1315 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1316 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1317
1318 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1319 // the right place.
1320 Instruction *NewVal;
1321 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1322 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
1323 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
1324 else
1325 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
1326 ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
1327 NewVal->takeName(I);
1328 InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
1329 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, NewVal);
1330 }
1331
1332 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1333 break;
1334 }
1335 }
1336 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001337 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001338 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001339 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001340
1341 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1342 // constant.
1343 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask)
1344 return UpdateValueUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(RHSKnownOne));
1345 return false;
1346}
1347
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001348
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001349/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001350/// 64 or fewer elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
1351/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1352/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1353///
1354/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1355/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1356/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
1357Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, uint64_t DemandedElts,
1358 uint64_t &UndefElts,
1359 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001360 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001361 assert(VWidth <= 64 && "Vector too wide to analyze!");
1362 uint64_t EltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001363 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001364
1365 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1366 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1367 UndefElts = EltMask;
1368 return 0;
1369 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1370 UndefElts = EltMask;
1371 return UndefValue::get(V->getType());
1372 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001373
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001374 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001375 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1376 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001377 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1378
1379 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1380 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1381 if (!(DemandedElts & (1ULL << i))) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
1382 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1383 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1384 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1385 Elts.push_back(Undef);
1386 UndefElts |= (1ULL << i);
1387 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1388 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1389 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001390
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001391 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001392 Constant *NewCP = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001393 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1394 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001395 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001396 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001397
1398 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1399 // anything.
1400 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1401 return 0;
1402
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001403 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001404 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(EltTy);
1405 Constant *Undef = UndefValue::get(EltTy);
1406 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1407 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
1408 Elts.push_back((DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) ? Zero : Undef);
1409 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001410 return ConstantVector::get(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001411 }
1412
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001413 // Limit search depth.
1414 if (Depth == 10)
1415 return false;
1416
1417 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1418 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1419 // are needed.
1420 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1421 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1422 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1423 // the main instcombine process.
1424 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001425 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
1426 return false;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001427
1428 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1429 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001430 }
1431
1432 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
1433 if (!I) return false; // Only analyze instructions.
1434
1435 bool MadeChange = false;
1436 uint64_t UndefElts2;
1437 Value *TmpV;
1438 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1439 default: break;
1440
1441 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1442 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1443 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001444 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001445 if (Idx == 0) {
1446 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1447 // which elt is getting updated.
1448 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1449 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1450 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1451 break;
1452 }
1453
1454 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1455 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001456 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001457 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || (DemandedElts & (1ULL << IdxNo)) == 0)
1458 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1459
1460 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1461 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
1462 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0),
1463 DemandedElts & ~(1ULL << IdxNo),
1464 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1465 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1466
1467 // The inserted element is defined.
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001468 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << IdxNo);
1469 break;
1470 }
1471 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1472 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001473 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1474 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001475 uint64_t LeftDemanded = 0, RightDemanded = 0;
1476 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1477 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << i)) {
1478 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1479 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001480 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001481 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001482 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001483 LeftDemanded |= 1ULL << MaskVal;
1484 else
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001485 RightDemanded |= 1ULL << (MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001486 }
1487 }
1488 }
1489
1490 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
1491 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1492 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1493
1494 uint64_t UndefElts3;
1495 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1496 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1497 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1498
1499 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1500 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1501 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001502 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001503 uint64_t NewBit = 1ULL << i;
1504 UndefElts |= NewBit;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001505 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001506 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts2 >> MaskVal) & 1) << i;
1507 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1508 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1509 } else {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001510 uint64_t NewBit = ((UndefElts3 >> (MaskVal - LHSVWidth)) & 1) << i;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001511 NewUndefElts |= NewBit;
1512 UndefElts |= NewBit;
1513 }
1514 }
1515
1516 if (NewUndefElts) {
1517 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1518 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1519 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
1520 if (UndefElts & (1ULL << i))
1521 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
1522 else
1523 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
1524 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1525 }
1526 I->setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
1527 MadeChange = true;
1528 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001529 break;
1530 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001531 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001532 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001533 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1534 if (!VTy) break;
1535 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
1536 uint64_t InputDemandedElts = 0;
1537 unsigned Ratio;
1538
1539 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001540 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001541 // elements as are demanded of us.
1542 Ratio = 1;
1543 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1544 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1545 // Untested so far.
1546 break;
1547
1548 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1549 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1550 // elements are live.
1551 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1552 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
1553 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << OutIdx))
1554 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio);
1555 }
1556 } else {
1557 // Untested so far.
1558 break;
1559
1560 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1561 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1562 // live.
1563 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1564 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1565 if (DemandedElts & (1ULL << InIdx/Ratio))
1566 InputDemandedElts |= 1ULL << InIdx;
1567 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001568
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001569 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1570 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1571 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1572 if (TmpV) {
1573 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1574 MadeChange = true;
1575 }
1576
1577 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1578 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1579 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1580 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1581 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1582 // undef.
1583 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
1584 if (UndefElts2 & (1ULL << (OutIdx/Ratio)))
1585 UndefElts |= 1ULL << OutIdx;
1586 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
1587 assert(0 && "Unimp");
1588 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1589 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1590 // elements are undef.
1591 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1592 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
1593 if ((UndefElts2 & (1ULL << InIdx)) == 0) // Not undef?
1594 UndefElts &= ~(1ULL << (InIdx/Ratio)); // Clear undef bit.
1595 }
1596 break;
1597 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001598 case Instruction::And:
1599 case Instruction::Or:
1600 case Instruction::Xor:
1601 case Instruction::Add:
1602 case Instruction::Sub:
1603 case Instruction::Mul:
1604 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1605 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1606 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1607 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1608 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1609 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1610 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1611
1612 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1613 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1614 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1615 break;
1616
1617 case Instruction::Call: {
1618 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1619 if (!II) break;
1620 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1621 default: break;
1622
1623 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1624 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1625 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1626 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1627 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1628 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1629 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1630 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1631 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1632 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1633 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1634 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1635 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1636 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1637 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1638 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1639
1640 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1641 // scalarize it now.
1642 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1643 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1644 default: break;
1645 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1646 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1647 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1648 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1649 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1650 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1651 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1652 // Extract the element as scalars.
1653 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1654 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS, 0U,"tmp"), *II);
1655
1656 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1657 default: assert(0 && "Case stmts out of sync!");
1658 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1659 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001660 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001661 II->getName()), *II);
1662 break;
1663 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1664 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001665 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001666 II->getName()), *II);
1667 break;
1668 }
1669
1670 Instruction *New =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001671 InsertElementInst::Create(UndefValue::get(II->getType()), TmpV, 0U,
1672 II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001673 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1674 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1675 return New;
1676 }
1677 }
1678
1679 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1680 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1681 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1682 break;
1683 }
1684 break;
1685 }
1686 }
1687 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1688}
1689
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001690
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001691/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1692/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1693/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1694/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1695/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1696/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1697/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1698///
1699template<typename Functor>
Dan Gohman76d402b2008-05-20 01:14:05 +00001700static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001701 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1702 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1703
1704 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1705 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1706 return F.apply(Root);
1707
1708 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1709 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001710 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001711 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1712 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1713
1714 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1715 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1716 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1717 ShouldApply = true;
1718 }
1719
1720 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1721 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1722 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001723 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1724 // and perform the reassociation.
1725 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1726
1727 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1728 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1729
1730 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1731 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001732 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001733 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
1734 return 0;
1735 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001736 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001737 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001738 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001739 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001740 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001741
1742 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1743 // get to LHSI.
1744 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1745 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001746 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1747 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001748 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001749 ARI = NextLHSI;
1750
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001751 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1752 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1753 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1754 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1755 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001756
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001757 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1758 // the transformation...
1759 return F.apply(Root);
1760 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001761
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001762 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1763 }
1764 return 0;
1765}
1766
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001767namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001768
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001769// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001770struct AddRHS {
1771 Value *RHS;
1772 AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
1773 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1774 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001775 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
1776 ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001777 }
1778};
1779
1780// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1781// iff C1&C2 == 0
1782struct AddMaskingAnd {
1783 Constant *C2;
1784 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
1785 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001786 ConstantInt *C1;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001787 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001788 ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001789 }
1790 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001791 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001792 }
1793};
1794
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001795}
1796
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001797static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001798 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001799 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00001800 return IC->InsertCastBefore(CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001801 }
1802
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001803 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001804 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1805 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001806
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001807 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1808 if (ConstIsRHS)
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001809 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1810 return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001811 }
1812
1813 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1814 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1815 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1816 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001817 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001818 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001819 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001820 New = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001821 SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001822 else {
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001823 assert(0 && "Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001824 abort();
1825 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001826 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1827}
1828
1829// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1830// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1831// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1832// not have a second operand.
1833static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1834 InstCombiner *IC) {
1835 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1836 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1837 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1838 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1839
1840 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001841 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001842 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001843
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001844 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1845 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1846
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001847 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1848 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001849 }
1850 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001851}
1852
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001853
1854/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1855/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1856/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1857Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1858 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001859 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001860 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001861
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001862 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1863 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001864 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001865 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1866 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1867 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1868 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001869 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001870 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1871
1872 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1873 // loop.
1874 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1875 return 0;
1876 }
1877
1878 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1879 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1880 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1881 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1882 if (NonConstBB) {
1883 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1884 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1885 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001886
1887 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001888 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001889 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001890 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001891 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001892
1893 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1894 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1895 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001896 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001897 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001898 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001899 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
1900 InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
1901 else
1902 InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001903 } else {
1904 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1905 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001906 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001907 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1908 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001909 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001910 InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001911 CI->getPredicate(),
1912 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1913 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001914 else
1915 assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
1916
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001917 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001918 }
1919 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001920 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001921 } else {
1922 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
1923 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001924 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001925 Value *InV;
1926 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001927 InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001928 } else {
1929 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001930 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001931 I.getType(), "phitmp",
1932 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00001933 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001934 }
1935 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001936 }
1937 }
1938 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
1939}
1940
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001941
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00001942/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
1943/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
1944/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
1945/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
1946bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
1947 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
1948 // ones.
1949
1950 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
1951 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
1952 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
1953 // sign extend fine.
1954 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
1955 return true;
1956
1957
1958 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
1959 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
1960 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
1961 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
1962
1963 // TODO: Implement.
1964
1965 return false;
1966}
1967
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00001968
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001969Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00001970 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00001971 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00001972
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001973 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00001974 // X + undef -> undef
1975 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
1976 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
1977
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001978 // X + 0 --> X
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00001979 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) { // NOTE: -0 + +0 = +0.
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001980 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
1981 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001982 } else if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Dale Johannesen9e3d3ab2007-09-14 22:26:36 +00001983 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
1984 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
Chris Lattner8532cf62005-10-17 20:18:38 +00001985 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Chris Lattner5e678e02005-10-17 17:56:38 +00001986 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001987
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00001988 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001989 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00001990 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001991 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001992 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001993 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00001994
1995 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
1996 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00001997 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
1998 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
1999 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
2000 KnownZero, KnownOne))
2001 return &I;
2002 }
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002003
2004 // zext(i1) - 1 -> select i1, 0, -1
2005 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
2006 if (CI->isAllOnesValue() &&
2007 ZI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2008 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0),
2009 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
2010 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002011 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002012
2013 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2014 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2015 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002016
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002017 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2018 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002019 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
2020 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002021 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002022 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002023
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002024 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002025 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2026 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002027 do {
2028 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002029 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2030 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002031 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2032 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002033 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002034 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2035 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002036 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002037 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002038 }
2039 }
2040 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002041 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2042 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2043 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002044
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002045 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002046 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2047 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2048 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002049 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2050 switch (Size) {
2051 default: break;
2052 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2053 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2054 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2055 }
2056 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002057 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002058 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002059 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002060 }
2061 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002062 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002063
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002064 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2065 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2066
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002067 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002068 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002069 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS))) return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002070
2071 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2072 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2073 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2074 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2075 }
2076 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2077 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2078 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2079 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2080 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002081 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002082
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002083 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002084 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
2085 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002086 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
2087 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002088 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002089 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002090 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002091 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002092 }
2093
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002094 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002095 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002096
2097 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002098 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
2099 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002100 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002101
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002102
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002103 ConstantInt *C2;
2104 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
2105 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002106 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002107
2108 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2109 ConstantInt *C1;
2110 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002111 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Add(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002112 }
2113
2114 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002115 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002116 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002117
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002118 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00002119 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS || dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
2120 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002121
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002122
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002123 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002124 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002125 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
2126 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002127
2128 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2129 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2130 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2131 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2132 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2133 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2134 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2135 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2136 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2137 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2138
2139 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002140 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002141 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002142 }
2143 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002144
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002145 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002146 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002147 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
2148 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
2149 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
2150 if (W != Y) {
2151 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002152 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002153 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002154 std::swap(W, X);
2155 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002156 std::swap(Y, Z);
2157 std::swap(W, X);
2158 }
2159 }
2160
2161 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002162 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002163 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002164 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002165 }
2166 }
2167 }
2168
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002169 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002170 Value *X = 0;
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002171 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002172 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002173
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002174 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
2175 if (LHS->hasOneUse() && match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002176 Constant *Anded = And(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002177 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2178 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2179 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002180 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002181
2182 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002183 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002184
2185 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002186 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002187
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002188 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2189 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002190 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002191 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002192 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002193 }
2194 }
2195 }
2196
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002197 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2198 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002199 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002200 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002201 }
2202
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002203 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002204 // cast (GEP (cast *A to sbyte*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002205 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002206 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2207 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002208 if (!CI) {
2209 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2210 Other = LHS;
2211 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002212 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002213 (CI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() ==
2214 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002215 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002216 unsigned AS =
2217 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002218 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
2219 PointerType::get(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002220 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2"), I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002221 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002222 }
2223 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002224
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002225 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002226 {
2227 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002228 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002229 if (!SI) {
2230 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002231 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002232 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002233 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002234 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2235 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002236 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002237
2238 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2239 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002240 if (match(FV, m_Zero()) && match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
2241 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002242 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002243 if (match(TV, m_Zero()) && match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
2244 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002245 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002246 }
2247 }
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002248
2249 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2250 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2251 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2252 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002253
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002254 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2255 // integer add followed by a sext.
2256 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2257 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2258 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2259 Constant *CI =
2260 ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2261 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2262 ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
2263 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2264 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2265 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2266 CI, "addconv");
2267 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2268 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2269 }
2270 }
2271
2272 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2273 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2274 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2275 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2276 // integer add will not overflow.
2277 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2278 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2279 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2280 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2281 // Insert the new integer add.
2282 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2283 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2284 "addconv");
2285 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2286 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2287 }
2288 }
2289 }
2290
2291 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2292 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2293 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2294 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2295 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2296 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2297 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2298 // instcombined.
2299 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2300 Constant *CI =
2301 ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
2302 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
2303 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
2304 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2305 // Insert the new integer add.
2306 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2307 CI, "addconv");
2308 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2309 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2310 }
2311 }
2312
2313 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2314 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2315 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2316 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2317 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2318 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2319 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2320 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2321 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2322 // Insert the new integer add.
2323 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2324 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2325 "addconv");
2326 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2327 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2328 }
2329 }
2330 }
2331
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002332 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002333}
2334
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002335Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002336 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002337
Chris Lattnerd137ab42008-07-17 06:07:20 +00002338 if (Op0 == Op1 && // sub X, X -> 0
2339 !I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002340 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002341
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002342 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002343 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002344 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002345
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002346 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2347 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2348 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2349 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2350
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002351 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2352 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002353 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002354 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002355
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002356 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002357 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002358 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002359 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002360
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002361 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2362 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002363 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002364 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002365 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002366 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002367 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002368 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002369 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002370 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002371 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002372 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002373 }
2374 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002375 }
2376 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2377 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2378 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002379 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002380 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002381 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002382 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002383 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002384 }
2385 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002386 }
2387 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002388 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002389
2390 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2391 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002392 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002393 return R;
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002394 }
2395
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002396 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2397 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2398
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002399 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2400 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002401 !Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002402 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002403 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002404 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002405 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0), I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002406 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2407 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2408 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002409 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Subtract(CI1, CI2),
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002410 Op1I->getOperand(0));
2411 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002412 }
2413
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002414 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002415 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2416 // is not used by anyone else...
2417 //
Chris Lattner0517e722004-02-02 20:09:56 +00002418 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002419 !Op1I->getType()->isFPOrFPVector()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002420 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2421 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2422 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2423 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002424
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002425 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002426 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002427 }
2428
2429 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2430 //
2431 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2432 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2433 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2434
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002435 Value *NewNot =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002436 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
2437 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002438 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002439
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002440 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002441 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002442 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002443 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002444 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002445 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002446 ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
2447
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002448 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002449 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002450 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002451 Constant *CP1 = Subtract(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1), C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002452 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002453 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002454 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002455 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002456
Chris Lattner9919e3d2006-12-02 00:13:08 +00002457 if (!Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002458 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002459 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002460 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2461 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2462 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2463 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002464 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2465 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002466 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1), I.getName());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00002467 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002468 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002469
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002470 ConstantInt *C1;
2471 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002472 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002473 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002474
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002475 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
2476 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002477 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Subtract(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002478 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002479 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002480}
2481
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002482/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2483/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2484/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2485/// signed.
2486static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2487 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002488 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002489 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2490 TrueIfSigned = true;
2491 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002492 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2493 TrueIfSigned = true;
2494 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002495 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2496 TrueIfSigned = false;
2497 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002498 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2499 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2500 TrueIfSigned = true;
2501 return RHS->getValue() ==
2502 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2503 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2504 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2505 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002506 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002507 default:
2508 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002509 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002510}
2511
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002512Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002513 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002514 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002515
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002516 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
2517 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2518
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002519 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002520 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2521 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002522
2523 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002524 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002525 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2526 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002527 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00002528 ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002529
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002530 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002531 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2532 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2533 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2534 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002535 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002536
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002537 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002538 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002539 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002540 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002541 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002542 } else if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002543 if (Op1F->isNullValue())
2544 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002545
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002546 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2547 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002548 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2549 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2550 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2551 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
2552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002553
2554 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2555 if (Op1V->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
2556 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
2557
2558 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2559 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
2560 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Splat))
2561 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2562 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2563 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Splat))
2564 if (CI->equalsInt(1))
2565 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2566 }
2567 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002568 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002569
2570 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2571 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002572 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002573 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002574 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002575 Op1, "tmp");
2576 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
2577 Value *C1C2 = ConstantExpr::getMul(Op1,
2578 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002579 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002580
2581 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002582
2583 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2584 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002585 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002586 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002587
2588 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2589 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2590 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002591 }
2592
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002593 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2594 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002595 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002596
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002597 // (X / Y) * Y = X - (X % Y)
2598 // (X / Y) * -Y = (X % Y) - X
2599 {
2600 Value *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2601 BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
2602 if (!BO ||
2603 (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::UDiv &&
2604 BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::SDiv)) {
2605 Op1 = Op0;
2606 BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1));
2607 }
2608 Value *Neg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1);
2609 if (BO && BO->hasOneUse() &&
2610 (BO->getOperand(1) == Op1 || BO->getOperand(1) == Neg) &&
2611 (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv ||
2612 BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)) {
2613 Value *Op0BO = BO->getOperand(0), *Op1BO = BO->getOperand(1);
2614
2615 Instruction *Rem;
2616 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
2617 Rem = BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
2618 else
2619 Rem = BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
2620
2621 InsertNewInstBefore(Rem, I);
2622 Rem->takeName(BO);
2623
2624 if (Op1BO == Op1)
2625 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Op0BO, Rem);
2626 else
2627 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Rem, Op0BO);
2628 }
2629 }
2630
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002631 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2632 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2633
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002634 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2635 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2636 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2637 // formed.
2638 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002639 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002640 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002641 BoolCast = CI;
2642 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002643 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002644 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002645 BoolCast = CI;
2646 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002647 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002648 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2649 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002650 bool TIS = false;
2651
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002652 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002653 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2654 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002655 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2656 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002657 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002658 Constant *Amt = ConstantInt::get(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002659 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002660 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002661 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002662 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002663 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2664 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002665
2666 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2667 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002668 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002669 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2670 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002671 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2672 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2673 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2674 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2675 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002676
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002677 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002678 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002679 }
2680 }
2681 }
2682
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002683 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002684}
2685
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002686/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2687/// instruction.
2688bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2689 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2690
2691 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2692 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2693 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2694 if (ST->isNullValue())
2695 NonNullOperand = 2;
2696 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2697 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2698 if (ST->isNullValue())
2699 NonNullOperand = 1;
2700
2701 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2702 return false;
2703
2704 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2705
2706 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2707 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2708
2709 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2710 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2711 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2712 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2713 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2714
2715 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2716 // early exit.
2717 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2718 return true;
2719
2720 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2721 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2722
2723 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2724 --BBI;
2725 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2726 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2727 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2728 break;
2729
2730 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2731 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2732 I != E; ++I) {
2733 if (*I == SI) {
2734 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2735 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2736 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
2737 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue() :
2738 ConstantInt::getFalse();
2739 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2740 }
2741 }
2742
2743 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2744 if (&*BBI == SI)
2745 SI = 0;
2746 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2747 SelectCond = 0;
2748
2749 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2750 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2751 break;
2752
2753 }
2754 return true;
2755}
2756
2757
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002758/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2759/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2760/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2761/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002762Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002763 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002764
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002765 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2766 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2767 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2768 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2769 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002770 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002771 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002772
2773 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002774 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002775 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002776
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002777 return 0;
2778}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002779
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002780/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2781/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2782/// division instructions.
2783/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002784Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002785 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2786
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002787 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002788 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2789 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
2790 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
2791 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
2792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
2793 }
2794
2795 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
2796 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2797 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002798
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002799 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2800 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002801
2802 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2803 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2804 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2805 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002806
2807 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2808 // div X, 1 == X
2809 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2810 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2811
2812 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2813 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2814 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2815 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002816 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS, I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
2817 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2818 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002819 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002820 Multiply(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002821 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002822
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002823 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002824 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2825 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2826 return R;
2827 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2828 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2829 return NV;
2830 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002831 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002832
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002833 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002834 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002835 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
2836 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2837
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002838 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2839 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2840 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2841
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002842 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2843 if (ConstantInt *X = cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2844 // div X, 1 == X
2845 if (X->isOne())
2846 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2847 }
2848
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002849 return 0;
2850}
2851
2852Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2853 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2854
2855 // Handle the integer div common cases
2856 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2857 return Common;
2858
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002859 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00002860 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
2861 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
2862 // if so, convert to a right shift.
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00002863 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002864 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00002865 ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00002866
2867 // X udiv C, where C >= signbit
2868 if (C->getValue().isNegative()) {
2869 Value *IC = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, C),
2870 I);
2871 return SelectInst::Create(IC, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
2872 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
2873 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002874 }
2875
2876 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002877 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002878 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
2879 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002880 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002881 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002882 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002883 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002884 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002885 Constant *C2V = ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002886 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002887 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002888 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00002889 }
2890 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00002891 }
2892
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002893 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
2894 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002895 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002896 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002897 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002898 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002899 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002900 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002901 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002902 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
2903 Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002904 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002905 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
2906 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
2907
2908 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
2909 Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002910 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002911 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
2912 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002913
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002914 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002915 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002916 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00002917 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002918 return 0;
2919}
2920
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002921Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2922 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2923
2924 // Handle the integer div common cases
2925 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
2926 return Common;
2927
2928 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2929 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
2930 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002931 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002932 }
2933
2934 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
2935 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00002936 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002937 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002938 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00002939 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002940 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002941 }
2942 }
2943
2944 return 0;
2945}
2946
2947Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2948 return commonDivTransforms(I);
2949}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002950
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002951/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
2952/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
2953/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
2954/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
2955Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002956 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002957
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002958 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002959 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
2960 if (LHS->isNullValue())
2961 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2962
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002963 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
2964 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2965 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002966 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002967 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002968 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002970
2971 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002972 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2973 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00002974
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00002975 return 0;
2976}
2977
2978/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
2979/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2980/// remainder instructions.
2981/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
2982Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
2983 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2984
2985 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
2986 return common;
2987
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002988 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00002989 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
2990 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
2991 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
2992
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002993 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
2994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
2995
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00002996 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
2997 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
2998 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2999 return R;
3000 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
3001 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3002 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003003 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003004
3005 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
3006 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3007 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3008 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
3009 KnownZero, KnownOne))
3010 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003011 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003012 }
3013
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003014 return 0;
3015}
3016
3017Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3018 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3019
3020 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3021 return common;
3022
3023 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3024 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3025 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3026 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3027 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003028 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003029 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003030 }
3031
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003032 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003033 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3034 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3035 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003036 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003037 Constant *N1 = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003038 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003039 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003040 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003041 }
3042 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003043 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003044
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003045 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3046 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3047 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3048 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3049 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3050 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003051 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3052 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003053 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003054 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO), SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003055 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003056 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO), SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003057 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003058 }
3059 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003060 }
3061
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003062 return 0;
3063}
3064
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003065Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3066 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3067
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003068 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003069 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3070 return common;
3071
3072 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003073 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3074 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3075 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003076 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3077 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3078 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3079 return &I;
3080 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003081
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003082 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003083 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003084 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3085 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3086 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3087 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003088 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003089 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003090 }
3091
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003092 // If it's a constant vector, flip any negative values positive.
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003093 if (ConstantVector *RHSV = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3094 unsigned VWidth = RHSV->getNumOperands();
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003095
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003096 bool hasNegative = false;
3097 for (unsigned i = 0; !hasNegative && i != VWidth; ++i)
3098 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i)))
3099 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
3100 hasNegative = true;
3101
3102 if (hasNegative) {
3103 std::vector<Constant *> Elts(VWidth);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003104 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
3105 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i))) {
3106 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
3107 Elts[i] = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
3108 else
3109 Elts[i] = RHS;
3110 }
3111 }
3112
3113 Constant *NewRHSV = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
3114 if (NewRHSV != RHSV) {
Nick Lewycky19c28922008-12-18 06:42:28 +00003115 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003116 I.setOperand(1, NewRHSV);
3117 return &I;
3118 }
3119 }
3120 }
3121
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003122 return 0;
3123}
3124
3125Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003126 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3127}
3128
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003129// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3130// constant.
3131static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003132 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003133}
3134
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003135// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3136// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3137static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003138 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003139}
3140
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003141/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003142/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3143///
3144/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3145///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003146/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3147/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003148///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003149/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3150/// 0 A > B
3151/// 1 A == B
3152/// 2 A < B
3153///
3154/// <=> Value Definition
3155/// 000 0 Always false
3156/// 001 1 A > B
3157/// 010 2 A == B
3158/// 011 3 A >= B
3159/// 100 4 A < B
3160/// 101 5 A != B
3161/// 110 6 A <= B
3162/// 111 7 Always true
3163///
3164static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3165 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003166 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003167 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3168 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3169 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3170 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3171 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3172 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3173 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3174 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3175 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3176 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003177 // True -> 7
3178 default:
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003179 assert(0 && "Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003180 return 0;
3181 }
3182}
3183
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003184/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3185/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3186/// predicate by reference.
3187static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3188 isOrdered = false;
3189 switch (CC) {
3190 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3191 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003192 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3193 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3194 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3195 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003196 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3197 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3198 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3199 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003200 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3201 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003202 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3203 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003204 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003205 default:
3206 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
3207 assert(0 && "Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
3208 return 0;
3209 }
3210}
3211
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003212/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3213/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003214/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003215/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003216static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3217 switch (code) {
3218 default: assert(0 && "Illegal ICmp code!");
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003219 case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003220 case 1:
3221 if (sign)
3222 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
3223 else
3224 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3225 case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
3226 case 3:
3227 if (sign)
3228 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
3229 else
3230 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3231 case 4:
3232 if (sign)
3233 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
3234 else
3235 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3236 case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
3237 case 6:
3238 if (sign)
3239 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
3240 else
3241 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003242 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003243 }
3244}
3245
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003246/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3247/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3248/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3249static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
3250 Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
3251 switch (code) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003252 default: assert(0 && "Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003253 case 0:
3254 if (isordered)
3255 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
3256 else
3257 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
3258 case 1:
3259 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003260 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
3261 else
3262 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003263 case 2:
3264 if (isordered)
3265 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
3266 else
3267 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003268 case 3:
3269 if (isordered)
3270 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
3271 else
3272 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
3273 case 4:
3274 if (isordered)
3275 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
3276 else
3277 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3278 case 5:
3279 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003280 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
3281 else
3282 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
3283 case 6:
3284 if (isordered)
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003285 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
3286 else
3287 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003288 case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue();
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003289 }
3290}
3291
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003292/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3293/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003294static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3295 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003296 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3297 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003298}
3299
3300namespace {
3301// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3302struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003303 InstCombiner &IC;
3304 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003305 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3306 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3307 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3308 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003309 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003310 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3311 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003312 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3313 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003314 return false;
3315 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003316 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3317 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3318 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3319 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3320 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003321 }
3322
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003323 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003324 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003325 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003326 unsigned Code;
3327 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3328 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3329 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3330 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Chris Lattner021c1902003-09-22 20:33:34 +00003331 default: assert(0 && "Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003332 }
3333
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003334 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3335 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3336
3337 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003338 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3339 return I;
3340 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3341 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3342 }
3343};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003344} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003345
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003346// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3347// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003348// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003349Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003350 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3351 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003352 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3353 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003354 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003355 if (!Op->isShift())
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003356 Together = And(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003357
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003358 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3359 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003360 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003361 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003362 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003363 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003364 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003365 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003366 }
3367 break;
3368 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003369 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3370 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003371
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003372 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3373 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003374 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003375 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003376 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003377 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003378 }
3379 break;
3380 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003381 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003382 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3383 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3384 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003385 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003386
3387 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003388 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003389 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3390 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3391 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003392 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003393
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003394 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3395 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3396 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3397 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3398 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3399 // no effect.
3400 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3401 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3402 return &TheAnd;
3403 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003404 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003405 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003406 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003407 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003408 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003409 }
3410 }
3411 }
3412 }
3413 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003414
3415 case Instruction::Shl: {
3416 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3417 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3418 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003419 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003420 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003421 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
3422 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003423
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003424 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3425 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003426 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3427 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003428 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3429 return &TheAnd;
3430 }
3431 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003432 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003433 case Instruction::LShr:
3434 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003435 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3436 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3437 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3438 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003439 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003440 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003441 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3442 ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003443
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003444 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3445 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003446 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3447 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3448 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3449 return &TheAnd;
3450 }
3451 break;
3452 }
3453 case Instruction::AShr:
3454 // Signed shr.
3455 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3456 // with an and.
3457 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003458 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003459 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003460 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
3461 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003462 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003463 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003464 // Make the argument unsigned.
3465 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003466 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003467 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003468 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003469 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003470 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003471 }
3472 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003473 }
3474 return 0;
3475}
3476
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003477
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003478/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3479/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003480/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3481/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003482/// insert new instructions.
3483Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003484 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3485 Instruction &IB) {
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003486 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003487 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003488 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003489
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003490 if (Inside) {
3491 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003492 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003493
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003494 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003495 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003496 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003497 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
3498 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3499 }
3500
3501 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
3502 Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003503 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003504 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003505 Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3506 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003507 }
3508
3509 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003510 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003511
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003512 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003513 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003514 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003515 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3516 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
3517 return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
3518 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003519
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003520 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3521 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
3522 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003523 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003524 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003525 Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
3526 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003527}
3528
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003529// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3530// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3531// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3532// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003533static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003534 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003535 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3536 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003537
3538 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003539 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003540 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003541 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003542 return true;
3543}
3544
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003545/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3546/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3547/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003548///
3549/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3550/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3551/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3552///
3553/// return (A +/- B).
3554///
3555Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003556 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003557 Instruction &I) {
3558 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3559 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3560 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3561
3562 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3563
3564 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3565 default: return 0;
3566 case Instruction::And:
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00003567 if (And(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003568 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003569 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3570 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3571 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003572 break;
3573
3574 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3575 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3576 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003577 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003578 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003579 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003580 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003581 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003582 break;
3583 }
3584 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003585 return 0;
3586 case Instruction::Or:
3587 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003588 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003589 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3590 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003591 && And(N, Mask)->isZero())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003592 break;
3593 return 0;
3594 }
3595
3596 Instruction *New;
3597 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003598 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003599 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003600 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003601 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3602}
3603
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003604/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
3605Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
3606 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003607 Value *Val, *Val2;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003608 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
3609 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3610
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003611 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 B, C2).
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003612 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003613 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003614 return 0;
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003615
3616 // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3617 // where C is a power of 2
3618 if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3619 LHSCst->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3620 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Val, Val2);
3621 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
3622 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
3623 }
3624
3625 // From here on, we only handle:
3626 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
3627 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
3628
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003629 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
3630 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3631 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3632 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
3633 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
3634 return 0;
3635
3636 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
3637 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
3638 return 0;
3639
3640 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003641 bool ShouldSwap;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003642 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3643 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3644 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003645 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003646 else
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003647 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
3648
3649 if (ShouldSwap) {
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003650 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3651 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3652 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3653 }
3654
3655 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3656 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3657 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3658 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3659 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3660 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3661 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3662
3663 switch (LHSCC) {
3664 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3665 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3666 switch (RHSCC) {
3667 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3668 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3669 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3670 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3671 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3672 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3673 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3674 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3675 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3676 }
3677 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3678 switch (RHSCC) {
3679 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3680 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3681 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
3682 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
3683 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3684 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3685 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
3686 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
3687 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3688 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3689 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3690 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3691 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3692 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3693 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
3694 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
3695 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
3696 Val->getName()+".off");
3697 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
3698 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
3699 ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
3700 }
3701 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3702 }
3703 break;
3704 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3705 switch (RHSCC) {
3706 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3707 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3708 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
3709 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3710 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3711 break;
3712 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3713 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3714 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3715 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3716 break;
3717 }
3718 break;
3719 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3720 switch (RHSCC) {
3721 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3722 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3723 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
3724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
3725 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3726 break;
3727 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3728 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3729 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3730 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3731 break;
3732 }
3733 break;
3734 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3735 switch (RHSCC) {
3736 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3737 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3738 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3739 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3740 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3741 break;
3742 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3743 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
3744 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
3745 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003746 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003747 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, false, true, I);
3748 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3749 break;
3750 }
3751 break;
3752 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3753 switch (RHSCC) {
3754 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
3755 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3756 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3757 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3758 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3759 break;
3760 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3761 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
3762 return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
3763 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003764 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) -> (X-14) s< 1
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003765 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst), RHSCst, true, true, I);
3766 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3767 break;
3768 }
3769 break;
3770 }
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003771
3772 return 0;
3773}
3774
3775
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003776Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003777 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003778 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003779
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003780 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
3781 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3782
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003783 // and X, X = X
3784 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003785 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003786
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003787 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003788 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003789 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00003790 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
3791 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
3792 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003793 KnownZero, KnownOne))
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003794 return &I;
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003795 } else {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003796 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003797 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003798 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003799 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3800 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003801 }
3802 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003803
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003804 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003805 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3806 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003807
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003808 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003809 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003810 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003811 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3812 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3813 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3814 case Instruction::Xor:
3815 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003816 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3817 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3818 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3819 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003820 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003821 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3822 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003823 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003824 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003825 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003826 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003827 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3828 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003829 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003830 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
3831 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003832 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003833 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
3834 }
3835 }
3836
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003837 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003838 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003839 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3840 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3841 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3842 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003843 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003844 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003845 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003846 break;
3847
3848 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003849 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
3850 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3851 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
3852 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003853 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003854
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003855 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
3856 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
3857 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3858 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
3859 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
3860 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
3861
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003862 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00003863 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
3864 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00003865 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
3866 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
3867 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
3868 }
3869 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003870 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003871
3872 case Instruction::Shl:
3873 case Instruction::LShr:
3874 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
3875 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00003876 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00003877 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0RHS,
3878 Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3879 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
3880 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
3881 }
3882 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003883 }
3884
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00003885 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003886 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003887 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003888 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003889 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
3890 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
3891 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
3892 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003893 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003894 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003895 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003896 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
3897 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003898 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
3899 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
3900 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003901 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003902 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
3903 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003904 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003905 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00003906 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003907 C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003908 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003909 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
3910 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
3911 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Chris Lattnerbb4e7b22006-12-12 19:11:20 +00003912 Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003913 if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS) // trunc(C1)&C2
3914 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
3915 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003916 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00003917 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00003918 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003919
3920 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
3921 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003922 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00003923 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00003924 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
3925 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3926 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003927 }
3928
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003929 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0);
3930 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003931
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00003932 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
3933 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
3934
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00003935 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00003936 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003937 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00003938 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00003939 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003940 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003941 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003942
3943 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003944 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
3945 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003946 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
3947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003948
3949 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
3950 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3951 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003952 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003953 }
3954 }
3955
3956 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003957 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
3958 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003959
3960 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
3961 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))))) {
3962 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003963 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00003964 }
3965 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003966
3967 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
3968 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3969 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
3970 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3971 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3972 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
3973 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
3974 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
3975 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
3976 }
3977 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00003978
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003979 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
3980 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
3981 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
3982 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
3983 std::swap(A, B);
3984 }
3985 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003986 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003987 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003988 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00003989 }
3990 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00003991
3992 // (A&((~A)|B)) -> A&B
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00003993 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)), m_Value(A))) ||
3994 match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)))))
3995 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op1);
3996 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)), m_Value(A))) ||
3997 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)))))
3998 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00003999 }
4000
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004001 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
4002 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4003 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004004 return R;
4005
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004006 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
4007 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4008 return Res;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00004009 }
4010
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004011 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004012 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
4013 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
4014 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
4015 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004016 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004017 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004018 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4019 I.getType(), TD) &&
4020 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4021 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004022 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004023 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4024 I.getName());
4025 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004026 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004027 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004028 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004029
4030 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004031 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4032 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4033 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004034 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4035 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4036 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004037 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004038 SI1->getOperand(0),
4039 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004040 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004041 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004042 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004043 }
4044
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004045 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004046 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4047 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4048 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004049 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
4050 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004051 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4052 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4053 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4054 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004055 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004056 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4057 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS->getOperand(0),
4058 RHS->getOperand(0));
4059 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004060 } else {
4061 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4062 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4063 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4064 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00004065 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4066 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4067 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4068 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4069 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004070 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4071 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4072 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4073 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4074 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE ||
4075 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4076 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4077 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4078 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4079 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4080 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4081 bool Op0Ordered;
4082 bool Op1Ordered;
4083 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4084 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4085 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4086 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4087 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4088 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4089 }
4090 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4091 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4092 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4093 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4094 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4095 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4096 // uno && ord -> false
4097 if (!Op0Ordered)
4098 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
4099 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4100 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4101 Op0LHS, Op0RHS));
4102 }
4103 }
4104 }
4105 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004106 }
4107 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004108
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004109 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004110}
4111
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004112/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4113/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4114/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4115/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4116/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4117/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4118/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4119/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4120/// match.
4121///
4122/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4123/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4124/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4125/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4126/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4127/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4128///
4129/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4130/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4131/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4132/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4133/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4134///
4135static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4136 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4137 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4138 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4139 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4140 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4141 ByteValues) ||
4142 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4143 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004144 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004145
4146 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4147 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4148 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4149 unsigned ShAmt =
4150 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4151 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4152 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4153 return true;
4154
4155 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4156 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4157 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4158 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4159 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4160 } else {
4161 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4162 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4163 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004164 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004165 }
4166
4167 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4168 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4169
4170 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4171 ByteValues);
4172 }
4173
4174 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4175 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4176 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4177 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4178 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4179 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4180 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4181 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4182
4183 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4184 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4185 // the and mask is.
4186 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4187 continue;
4188
4189 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4190 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4191 if (MaskB == 0) {
4192 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4193 continue;
4194 }
4195
4196 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4197 if (MaskB != Byte)
4198 return true;
4199
4200 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4201 }
4202
4203 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4204 ByteValues);
4205 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004206 }
4207
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004208 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4209 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4210 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4211 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4212 // their ultimate destination.
4213 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4214 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004215
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004216 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4217 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4218 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4219 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4220 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4221 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4222 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4223 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4224 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4225 return true;
4226 } else {
4227 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4228 return true;
4229 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004230
4231 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4232 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004233 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004234 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004235 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004236 return false;
4237}
4238
4239/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4240/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4241Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004242 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004243 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4244 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4245 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004246 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004247
4248 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4249 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004250 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004251 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004252
4253 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004254 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4255 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004256 return 0;
4257
4258 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4259 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4260 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4261
4262 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4263 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4264 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4265 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004266 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004267 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004268 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004269 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004270}
4271
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004272/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4273/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4274/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4275static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
4276 Value *C, Value *D) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004277 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004278 Value *Cond = 0;
Chris Lattner159c35b2009-01-05 23:53:12 +00004279 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Value(Cond))))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004280 return 0;
4281
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004282 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Chris Lattner159c35b2009-01-05 23:53:12 +00004283 if (match(D, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004284 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Chris Lattner159c35b2009-01-05 23:53:12 +00004285 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004286 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4287 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Chris Lattner159c35b2009-01-05 23:53:12 +00004288 if (match(B, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004289 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattner159c35b2009-01-05 23:53:12 +00004290 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004291 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004292 return 0;
4293}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004294
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004295/// FoldOrOfICmps - Fold (icmp)|(icmp) if possible.
4296Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I,
4297 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
4298 Value *Val, *Val2;
4299 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4300 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4301
4302 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 B, C2).
4303 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
4304 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
4305 return 0;
4306
4307 // From here on, we only handle:
4308 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4309 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
4310
4311 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4312 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4313 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4314 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
4315 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4316 return 0;
4317
4318 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4319 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
4320 return 0;
4321
4322 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4323 bool ShouldSwap;
4324 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
4325 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
4326 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
4327 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4328 else
4329 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4330
4331 if (ShouldSwap) {
4332 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4333 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4334 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4335 }
4336
4337 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4338 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4339 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4340 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4341 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4342 // equal.
4343 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4344
4345 switch (LHSCC) {
4346 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4347 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4348 switch (RHSCC) {
4349 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4350 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4351 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) { // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4352 Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
4353 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
4354 Val->getName()+".off");
4355 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
4356 AddCST = Subtract(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
4357 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
4358 }
4359 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4360 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4361 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4362 break;
4363 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4364 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4365 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4366 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4367 }
4368 break;
4369 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4370 switch (RHSCC) {
4371 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4372 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4373 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4374 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4376 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4377 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4378 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4379 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4380 }
4381 break;
4382 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4383 switch (RHSCC) {
4384 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4385 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4386 break;
4387 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4388 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4389 // this can cause overflow.
4390 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4391 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4392 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), false, false, I);
4393 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4394 break;
4395 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4396 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4397 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4398 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4399 break;
4400 }
4401 break;
4402 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4403 switch (RHSCC) {
4404 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4405 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4406 break;
4407 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4408 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4409 // this can cause overflow.
4410 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4412 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst), true, false, I);
4413 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4414 break;
4415 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4416 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4417 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4418 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4419 break;
4420 }
4421 break;
4422 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4423 switch (RHSCC) {
4424 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4425 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4426 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4427 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4428 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4429 break;
4430 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4431 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4432 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4433 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4434 break;
4435 }
4436 break;
4437 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4438 switch (RHSCC) {
4439 default: assert(0 && "Unknown integer condition code!");
4440 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4441 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4442 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4443 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4444 break;
4445 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4446 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
4447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4448 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4449 break;
4450 }
4451 break;
4452 }
4453 return 0;
4454}
4455
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004456/// FoldOrWithConstants - This helper function folds:
4457///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004458/// ((A | B) & C1) | (B & C2)
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004459///
4460/// into:
4461///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004462/// (A & C1) | B
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004463///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004464/// when the XOR of the two constants is "all ones" (-1).
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004465Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004466 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C) {
Bill Wendlingdda74e02008-12-02 05:06:43 +00004467 ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4468 if (!CI1) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004469
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004470 Value *V1 = 0;
4471 ConstantInt *CI2 = 0;
4472 if (!match(Op, m_And(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CI2)))) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004473
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00004474 APInt Xor = CI1->getValue() ^ CI2->getValue();
4475 if (!Xor.isAllOnesValue()) return 0;
4476
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004477 if (V1 == A || V1 == B) {
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00004478 Instruction *NewOp =
Bill Wendlingd16c6e92008-12-02 06:22:04 +00004479 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd((V1 == A) ? B : A, CI1), I);
4480 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NewOp, V1);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004481 }
4482
4483 return 0;
4484}
4485
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004486Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004487 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004488 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004489
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004490 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004491 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004492
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004493 // or X, X = X
4494 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004495 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004496
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004497 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4498 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004499 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4500 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4501 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4502 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4503 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4504 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004505 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4506 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4507 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4508 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4509 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004510 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004511
4512
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004513
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004514 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004515 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004516 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004517 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
4518 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004519 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004520 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004521 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004522 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004523 ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004524 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004525
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004526 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
4527 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) && isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004528 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004529 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004530 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004531 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004532 ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004533 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004534
4535 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4536 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004537 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004538 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004539 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4540 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4541 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004542 }
4543
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004544 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4545 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004546
4547 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4548 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4549 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4550 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))
4551 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4552 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4553
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004554 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4555 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004556 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004557 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
4558 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
4559 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004560 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4561 return BSwap;
4562 }
4563
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004564 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4565 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004566 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004567 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004568 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4569 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004570 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004571 }
4572
4573 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
4574 if (Op1->hasOneUse() && match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004575 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004576 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004577 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4578 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004579 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004580 }
4581
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004582 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004583 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004584 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
4585 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004586 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4587 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4588 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4589 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4590 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4591 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4592 // replace with V+N.
4593 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4594 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
4595 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4596 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4597 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4598 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4599 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4600 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4601 }
4602 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4603 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
4604 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
4605 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4606 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4607 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4608 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4609 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4610 }
4611 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004612 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004613 }
4614
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004615 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4616 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004617 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4618 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4619 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4620 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4621 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4622 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4623 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4624 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4625 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4626
4627 if (V1) {
4628 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004629 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4630 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004631 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004632 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004633
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004634 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004635 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D))
4636 return Match;
4637 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C))
4638 return Match;
4639 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D))
4640 return Match;
4641 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C))
4642 return Match;
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004643
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004644 // ((A&~B)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004645 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
4646 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
4647 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004648 // ((~B&A)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004649 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
4650 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
4651 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004652 // ((A&~B)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004653 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
4654 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
4655 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004656 // ((~B&A)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004657 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
4658 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
4659 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, B);
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004660 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004661
4662 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004663 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4664 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4665 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004666 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4667 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4668 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004669 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004670 SI1->getOperand(0),
4671 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004672 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004673 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004674 }
4675 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004676
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004677 // ((A|B)&1)|(B&-2) -> (A&1) | B
4678 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
4679 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004680 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op1, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004681 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004682 }
4683 // (B&-2)|((A|B)&1) -> (A&1) | B
4684 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
4685 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004686 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op0, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004687 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004688 }
4689
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004690 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)))) { // ~A | Op1
4691 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004692 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004693 } else {
4694 A = 0;
4695 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004696 // Note, A is still live here!
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004697 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)))) { // Op0 | ~B
4698 if (Op0 == B)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004699 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004700
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004701 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004702 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004703 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004704 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004705 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004706 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004707 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004708
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004709 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4710 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4711 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004712 return R;
4713
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004714 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
4715 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4716 return Res;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004717 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004718
4719 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004720 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004721 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004722 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004723 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4724 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4725 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4726 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4727 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4728 // generated.
4729 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4730 I.getType(), TD) &&
4731 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4732 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004733 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004734 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4735 I.getName());
4736 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004737 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004738 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004739 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004740 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004741 }
4742
4743
4744 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4745 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4746 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4747 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004748 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004749 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004750 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4751 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4752 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4753 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004754 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004755 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4756
4757 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4758 // rest.
4759 return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS->getOperand(0),
4760 RHS->getOperand(0));
4761 }
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004762 } else {
4763 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4764 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
4765 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS), m_Value(Op0RHS))) &&
4766 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS), m_Value(Op1RHS)))) {
4767 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4768 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4769 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4770 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4771 }
4772 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4773 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4774 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4775 return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4776 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE ||
4777 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4778 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
4779 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4780 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4781 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4782 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4783 bool Op0Ordered;
4784 bool Op1Ordered;
4785 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4786 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4787 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4788 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4789 // or'ed predicates.
4790 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4791 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4792 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4793 return I;
4794 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4796 }
4797 }
4798 }
4799 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004800 }
4801 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004802
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004803 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004804}
4805
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004806namespace {
4807
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004808// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4809struct XorSelf {
4810 Value *RHS;
4811 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4812 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4813 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
4814 return &Xor;
4815 }
4816};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004817
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004818}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004819
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004820Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004821 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004822 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004823
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004824 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
4825 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
4826 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
4827 // idiom (misuse).
4828 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004829 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00004830 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004831
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004832 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
4833 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00004834 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004835 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004836 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004837
4838 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4839 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004840 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4841 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())->getBitWidth();
4842 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
4843 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
4844 KnownZero, KnownOne))
4845 return &I;
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004846 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4847 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004848 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004849
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004850 // Is this a ~ operation?
4851 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
4852 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4853 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
4854 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
4855 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
4856 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4857 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1))) Op0I->swapOperands();
4858 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
4859 Instruction *NotY =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004860 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004861 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
4862 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
4863 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004864 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004865 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004866 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004867 }
4868 }
4869 }
4870 }
4871
4872
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004873 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004874 if (RHS == ConstantInt::getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Bill Wendling3479be92009-01-01 01:18:23 +00004875 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004876 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004877 return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
4878 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00004879
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00004880 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
4881 return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
4882 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
4883 }
4884
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00004885 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
4886 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
4887 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
4888 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
4889 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
4890 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
4891 if (RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode, ConstantInt::getTrue(),
4892 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
4893 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
4894 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
4895 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
4896 NewCI->takeName(CI);
4897 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
4898 }
4899 }
4900 }
4901 }
4902 }
4903
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004904 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00004905 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004906 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
4907 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004908 Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
4909 Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004910 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004911 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004912 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004913
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004914 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004915 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004916 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004917 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004918 Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004919 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004920 ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004921 ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00004922 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00004923 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00004924 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
4925 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004926 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00004927
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00004928 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004929 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4930 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004931 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004932 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
4933 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
4934 // NewRHS.
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00004935 Constant *CommonBits = And(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004936 NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
4937 ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00004938 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00004939 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
4940 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
4941 return &I;
4942 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00004943 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004944 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00004945 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004946
4947 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4948 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004949 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004950 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004951 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4952 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4953 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004954 }
4955
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004956 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004957 if (X == Op1)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004958 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004959
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004960 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004961 if (X == Op0)
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00004962 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004963
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004964
4965 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
4966 if (Op1I) {
4967 Value *A, *B;
4968 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
4969 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004970 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004971 I.swapOperands();
4972 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004973 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004974 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00004975 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004976 }
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00004977 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)))) {
4978 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // A^(A^B) == B
4979 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op0)))) {
4980 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // A^(B^A) == B
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004981 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004982 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004983 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00004984 std::swap(A, B);
4985 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004986 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004987 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
4988 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4989 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00004990 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00004991 }
4992
4993 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
4994 if (Op0I) {
4995 Value *A, *B;
4996 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4997 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
4998 std::swap(A, B);
4999 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
5000 Instruction *NotB =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005001 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"), I);
5002 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005003 }
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005004 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)))) {
5005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // (A^B)^A == B
5006 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op1)))) {
5007 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // (B^A)^A == B
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005008 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) && Op0I->hasOneUse()){
5009 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
5010 std::swap(A, B);
5011 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00005012 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005013 Instruction *N =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005014 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(A, "tmp"), I);
5015 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005016 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005017 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005018 }
5019
5020 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
5021 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
5022 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
5023 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5024 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
5025 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005026 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005027 Op1I->getOperand(0),
5028 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005029 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005030 Op1I->getOperand(1));
5031 }
5032
5033 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
5034 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5035 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
5036 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5037 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5038 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005039 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005040 }
5041 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
5042 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5043 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5044 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005045 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005046 }
5047
5048 // (A & B)^(C & D)
5049 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
5050 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
5051 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
5052 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
5053 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5054 if (A == C)
5055 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
5056 else if (A == D)
5057 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
5058 else if (B == C)
5059 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
5060 else if (B == D)
5061 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
5062
5063 if (X) {
5064 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005065 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
5066 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005067 }
5068 }
5069 }
5070
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005071 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
5072 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
5073 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00005074 return R;
5075
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005076 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005077 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005078 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005079 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
5080 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005081 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005082 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005083 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
5084 I.getType(), TD) &&
5085 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
5086 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005087 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005088 Op1C->getOperand(0),
5089 I.getName());
5090 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005091 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005092 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005093 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005094 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005095
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005096 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005097}
5098
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005099/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
5100/// overflowed for this type.
5101static bool AddWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005102 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00005103 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Add(In1, In2));
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005104
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005105 if (IsSigned)
5106 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5107 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5108 else
5109 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5110 else
5111 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005112}
5113
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005114/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
5115/// overflowed for this type.
5116static bool SubWithOverflow(ConstantInt *&Result, ConstantInt *In1,
5117 ConstantInt *In2, bool IsSigned = false) {
Dan Gohmanbcb37fd2008-09-11 18:53:02 +00005118 Result = cast<ConstantInt>(Subtract(In1, In2));
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005119
5120 if (IsSigned)
5121 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5122 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5123 else
5124 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5125 else
5126 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5127}
5128
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005129/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
5130/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
5131/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
5132static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
5133 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5134 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005135 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5136 Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005137
5138 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005139 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005140 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005141
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005142 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5143 ++i, ++GTI) {
5144 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00005145 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypePaddedSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005146 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5147 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5148
5149 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5150 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5151 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5152
5153 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
5154 Result = ConstantInt::get(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005155 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005156 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005157 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005158 ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
5159 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5160 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005161 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005162
5163 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5164 Constant *OC = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5165 Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
5166 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
5167 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(RC, Scale);
5168 else {
5169 // Emit an add instruction.
5170 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005171 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005172 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005173 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005174 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005175 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005176 // Convert to correct type.
5177 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
5178 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5179 Op = ConstantExpr::getSExt(OpC, IntPtrTy);
5180 else
5181 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new SExtInst(Op, IntPtrTy,
5182 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
5183 }
5184 if (Size != 1) {
5185 Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
5186 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
5187 Op = ConstantExpr::getMul(OpC, Scale);
5188 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005189 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005190 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5191 }
5192
5193 // Emit an add instruction.
5194 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
5195 Result = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
5196 cast<Constant>(Result));
5197 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005198 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005199 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005200 }
5201 return Result;
5202}
5203
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005204
5205/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return an value that can be used to compare of
5206/// the *offset* implied by GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we want
5207/// to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can be
5208/// complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be legal
5209/// to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32). This
5210/// later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed to
5211/// generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
5212///
5213/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5214///
5215static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5216 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005217 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5218 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5219
5220 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5221 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5222 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5223 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5224 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5225 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5226 int64_t Offset = 0;
5227 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5228 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5229 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5230 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5231
5232 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5233 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5234 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5235 } else {
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00005236 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypePaddedSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005237 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5238 }
5239 } else {
5240 // Found our variable index.
5241 break;
5242 }
5243 }
5244
5245 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5246 // evaluate it the general way.
5247 if (i == e) return 0;
5248
5249 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5250 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5251 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00005252 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getTypePaddedSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005253
5254 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5255 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5256 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5257 if (!CI) return 0;
5258
5259 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5260 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5261
5262 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5263 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5264 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5265 } else {
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00005266 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypePaddedSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005267 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5268 }
5269 }
5270
5271 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5272 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5273 // the index.
5274 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5275 if (Offset == 0) {
5276 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5277 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5278 // computation crosses zero.
5279 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5280 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5281 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5282 return VariableIdx;
5283 }
5284
5285 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5286 // the pointer size, so get it.
5287 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5288
5289 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5290 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5291
5292 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5293 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5294 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5295 // multiple of the variable scale.
5296 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5297 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5298 return 0;
5299
5300 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5301 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5302 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005303 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005304 true /*SExt*/,
5305 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5306 Constant *OffsetVal = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005307 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005308}
5309
5310
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005311/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005312/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005313Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5314 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5315 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005316 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005317
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005318 // Look through bitcasts.
5319 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5320 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005321
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005322 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
5323 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005324 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005325 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5326 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5327 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5328
5329 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5330 if (Offset == 0)
5331 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005332 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
5333 Constant::getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005334 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005335 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5336 // compare the base pointer.
5337 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5338 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005339 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005340 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005341 if (IndicesTheSame)
5342 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5343 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5344 IndicesTheSame = false;
5345 break;
5346 }
5347
5348 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5349 if (IndicesTheSame)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005350 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
5351 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005352
5353 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5354 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005355 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005356 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005357
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005358 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5359 bool AllZeros = true;
5360 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5361 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5362 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5363 AllZeros = false;
5364 break;
5365 }
5366 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005367 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5368 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005369
5370 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005371 AllZeros = true;
5372 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5373 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5374 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5375 AllZeros = false;
5376 break;
5377 }
5378 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005379 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005380
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005381 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5382 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5383 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5384 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5385 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5386 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005387 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5388 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005389 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005390 NumDifferences = 2;
5391 break;
5392 } else {
5393 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5394 DiffOperand = i;
5395 }
5396 }
5397
5398 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5399 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005400 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005401 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005402
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005403 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005404 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5405 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005406 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
5407 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005408 }
5409 }
5410
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005411 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005412 // the result to fold to a constant!
5413 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5414 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5415 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5416 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5417 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005418 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005419 }
5420 }
5421 return 0;
5422}
5423
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005424/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5425///
5426Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5427 Instruction *LHSI,
5428 Constant *RHSC) {
5429 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5430 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5431
5432 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5433 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005434 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005435 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5436
5437 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5438 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5439 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
5440 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5441
5442 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005443 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5444 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005445 ++InputSize;
5446
5447 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5448 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5449 return 0;
5450
5451 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5452 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5453 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5454 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5455
5456 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5457 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5458 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected predicate!");
5459 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005460 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5461 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5462 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005463 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005464 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5465 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5466 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005467 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005468 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5469 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5470 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005471 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005472 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5473 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5474 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005475 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005476 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5477 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5478 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005479 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005480 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5481 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5482 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005483 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005485 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005486 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005487 }
5488
5489 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5490
5491 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5492
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005493 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005494 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
5495 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
5496
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005497 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5498 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5499 // and large values.
5500 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5501 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5502 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5503 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5504 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5505 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005506 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5507 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005508 }
5509 } else {
5510 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5511 // +INF and large values.
5512 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5513 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5514 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5515 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5516 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5517 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005518 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5519 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005520 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005521 }
5522
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005523 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5524 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5525 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5526 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5527 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5528 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5529 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5530 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005531 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I,ConstantInt::getTrue());
5532 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005533 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005534 }
5535
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005536 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5537 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5538 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5539 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005540 Constant *RHSInt = ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
5541 if (!RHS.isZero() &&
5542 ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) != RHSC) {
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005543 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust the
5544 // compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards zero
5545 // at this point.
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005546 switch (Pred) {
5547 default: assert(0 && "Unexpected integer comparison!");
5548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005549 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005550 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005551 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005552 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5553 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5554 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5555 if (RHS.isNegative())
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005556 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005557 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5559 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5560 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5561 if (RHS.isNegative())
5562 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5563 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005564 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5565 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5566 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5567 if (RHS.isNegative())
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005568 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005569 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5570 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005571 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5572 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5573 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5574 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5575 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5576 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005577 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5578 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5579 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5580 if (RHS.isNegative())
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005581 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005582 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005583 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5584 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5585 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5586 if (RHS.isNegative())
5587 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5588 break;
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005589 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5590 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5591 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5592 if (!RHS.isNegative())
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005594 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5595 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005596 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5597 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5598 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5599 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5600 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5601 break;
5602 }
5603 }
5604
5605 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5606 // comparison.
5607 return new ICmpInst(Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
5608}
5609
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005610Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5611 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005612 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005613
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005614 // Fold trivial predicates.
5615 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005616 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005617 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005618 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005619
5620 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5621 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5622 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5623 default: assert(0 && "Unknown predicate!");
5624 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5625 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5626 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005627 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005628 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5629 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5630 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005631 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005632
5633 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5634 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5635 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5636 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5637 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5638 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
5639 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5640 return &I;
5641
5642 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5643 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5644 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5645 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5646 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5647 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
5648 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
5649 return &I;
5650 }
5651 }
5652
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005653 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005654 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005655
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005656 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5657 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005658 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5659 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5660 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5661 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005662 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005663 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5664 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5665 // True if unordered.
Eli Friedman8b019c82008-11-30 22:48:49 +00005666 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005667 }
5668 }
5669
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005670 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5671 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5672 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005673 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5674 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5675 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5676 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5677 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5678 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005679 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005680 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5681 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5682 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5683 return NV;
5684 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005685 case Instruction::Select:
5686 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5687 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5688 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5689 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5690 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5691 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5692 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5693 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5694 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5695 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5696 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5697 I.getName()), I);
5698 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5699 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
5700 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5701 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
5702 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5703 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5704 I.getName()), I);
5705 }
5706 }
5707
5708 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005709 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005710 break;
5711 }
5712 }
5713
5714 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5715}
5716
5717Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5718 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5719 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5720 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5721
5722 // icmp X, X
5723 if (Op0 == Op1)
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005724 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005725 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005726
5727 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005728 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005729
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005730 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005731 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005732 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5733 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5734 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005735 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00005736 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005737 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005738
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005739 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005740 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005741 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5742 default: assert(0 && "Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005743 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005744 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005745 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005746 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005747 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005748 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005749 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005750
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005751 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005752 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005753 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005754 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005755 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005756 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005757 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005758 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005759 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5760 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005761 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005762 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
5763 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5764 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5765 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
5766 }
5767 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5768 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
5769 // FALL THROUGH
5770 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005771 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005772 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005773 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005774 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005775 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5776 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
5777 // FALL THROUGH
5778 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
5779 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
5780 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
5781 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
5782 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00005783 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005784 }
5785
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005786 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005787 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00005788 Value *A, *B;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005789
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00005790 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
5791 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
5792 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
5793 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
5794 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00005795 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00005796
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005797 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
5798 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
5799 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005800 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
5801 default: break;
5802 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5803 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
5804 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5805 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5806 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5807 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
5808 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5809 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5810 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5811 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
5812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5813 return new ICmpInst( ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5814 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5815 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
5816 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5817 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5818 }
5819
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005820 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
5821 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
5822 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Ty)->getBitWidth();
5823 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
5824
5825 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005826 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005827 bool UnusedBit;
5828 bool isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
5829
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00005830 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(Op0,
5831 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
5832 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005833 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0))
5834 return &I;
5835
5836 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005837 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
5838 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
5839 APInt Min(BitWidth, 0), Max(BitWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005840 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate()))
5841 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne, Min, Max);
5842 else
5843 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne,Min,Max);
5844
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005845 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
5846 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
5847 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
5848 if (Min == Max)
5849 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(),
5850 ConstantInt::get(Min),
5851 CI));
5852
5853 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
5854 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
5855 const APInt &RHSVal = CI->getValue();
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005856 switch (I.getPredicate()) { // LE/GE have been folded already.
5857 default: assert(0 && "Unknown icmp opcode!");
5858 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
5859 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5860 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
5861 break;
5862 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
5863 if (Max.ult(RHSVal) || Min.ugt(RHSVal))
5864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
5865 break;
5866 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005867 if (Max.ult(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005868 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005869 if (Min.uge(RHSVal)) // A <u C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005870 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005871 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <u MAX -> A != MAX
5872 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5873 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <u MIN+1 -> A == MIN
5874 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
5875
5876 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
5877 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
5878 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
5879 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005880 break;
5881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005882 if (Min.ugt(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005883 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005884 if (Max.ule(RHSVal)) // A >u C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005885 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005886
5887 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >u MIN -> A != MIN
5888 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5889 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >u MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5890 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
5891
5892 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
5893 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
5894 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
5895 ConstantInt::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005896 break;
5897 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005898 if (Max.slt(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> true iff max(A) < C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005899 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattnerd01bee72008-07-11 06:40:29 +00005900 if (Min.sge(RHSVal)) // A <s C -> false iff min(A) >= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005901 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005902 if (RHSVal == Max) // A <s MAX -> A != MAX
5903 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera8ff4a82008-07-11 06:36:01 +00005904 if (RHSVal == Min+1) // A <s MIN+1 -> A == MIN
Chris Lattnerf9685ac2008-07-11 06:38:16 +00005905 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, SubOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005906 break;
5907 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005908 if (Min.sgt(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> true iff min(A) > C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005909 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005910 if (Max.sle(RHSVal)) // A >s C -> false iff max(A) <= C
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005911 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00005912
5913 if (RHSVal == Min) // A >s MIN -> A != MIN
5914 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
5915 if (RHSVal == Max-1) // A >s MAX-1 -> A == MAX
5916 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0, AddOne(CI));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00005917 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00005918 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00005919 }
5920
5921 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
5922 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
5923 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
5924 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
5925 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
5926 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
5927 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
5928 if (I.hasOneUse())
5929 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
5930 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
5931 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
5932 return 0;
5933
5934 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
5935 // can be folded into the comparison.
5936 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005937 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00005938 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005939 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00005940 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005941 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
5942 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005943 }
5944
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00005945 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005946 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
5947 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5948 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005949 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
5950 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005951 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005952 bool isAllZeros = true;
5953 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5954 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
5955 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5956 isAllZeros = false;
5957 break;
5958 }
5959 if (isAllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005960 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00005961 Constant::getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
5962 }
5963 break;
5964
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005965 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005966 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5967 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5968 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5969 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5970 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5971 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005972 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00005973 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005974 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5975 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5976 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5977 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5978 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5979 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5980 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005981 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5982 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5983 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5984 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5985 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005986 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5987 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005988 Op2 = ConstantExpr::getICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
5989 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
5990 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(),
5991 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5992 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005993 }
5994 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00005995
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005996 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005997 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00005998 break;
5999 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006000 case Instruction::Malloc:
6001 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
6002 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
6003 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
6004 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00006006 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006007 }
6008 break;
6009 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006010 }
6011
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006012 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006013 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006014 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006015 return NI;
6016 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006017 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
6018 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006019 return NI;
6020
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006021 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006022 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
6023 // now.
6024 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
6025 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
6026 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006027 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
6028 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006029 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006030
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006031 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
6032 // so eliminate it as well.
6033 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
6034 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006035
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006036 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006037 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006038 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00006039 Op1 = ConstantExpr::getBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006040 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006041 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006042 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006043 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006044 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006045 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006046 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006047 }
6048
6049 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006050 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006051 // This comes up when you have code like
6052 // int X = A < B;
6053 // if (X) ...
6054 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006055 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
6056 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006057 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006058 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006059 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006060
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006061 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
6062 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6063 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006064 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
6065 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
6066 I.isEquality()) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00006067 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006068 default: break;
6069 case Instruction::Add:
6070 case Instruction::Sub:
6071 case Instruction::Xor:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006072 // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
6073 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
6074 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006075 break;
6076 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006077 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6078 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
6079 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
6080 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
6081 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
6082 ConstantInt *Mask = ConstantInt::get(
6083 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
6084 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006085 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006086 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
6087 Mask);
6088 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
6089 Mask);
6090 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
6091 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
6092 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006093 }
6094 }
6095 break;
6096 }
6097 }
6098 }
6099 }
6100
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006101 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
6102 { Value *A, *B;
6103 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A))) &&
6104 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B))))
6105 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, A);
6106 }
6107
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006108 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006109 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006110
6111 // -x == -y --> x == y
6112 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A))) &&
6113 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B))))
6114 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, B);
6115
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006116 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
6117 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
6118 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
6119 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
6120 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
6121 }
6122
6123 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
6124 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006125 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
6126 if (match(B, m_ConstantInt(C1)) &&
6127 match(D, m_ConstantInt(C2)) && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
6128 Constant *NC = ConstantInt::get(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
6129 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
6130 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A,
6131 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
6132 }
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006133
6134 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
6135 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6136 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6137 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6138 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), A, C);
6139 }
6140 }
6141
6142 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6143 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006144 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6145 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006146 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
6147 Constant::getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006148 }
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006149
6150 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
6151 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B))))
6152 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6153 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
6154
6155 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
6156 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B))))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006157 return new ICmpInst(I.getPredicate(), B,
6158 Constant::getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006159
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006160 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6161 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
6162 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
6163 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
6164 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6165
6166 if (A == C) {
6167 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6168 } else if (A == D) {
6169 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6170 } else if (B == C) {
6171 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6172 } else if (B == D) {
6173 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6174 }
6175
6176 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006177 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
6178 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006179 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
6180 I.setOperand(1, Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
6181 return &I;
6182 }
6183 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006184 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006185 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006186}
6187
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006188
6189/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6190/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6191Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6192 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6193 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6194 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6195
6196 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6197 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6198 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6199 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6200 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6201 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6202 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6203 // if it finds it.
6204 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6205 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6206 return 0;
6207 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006208 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006209 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6210 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6211 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6212 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6213 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006214
6215 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6216 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6217 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6218 // instead of computing a divide.
6219 ConstantInt *Prod = Multiply(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
6220
6221 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6222 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6223 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
6224 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? ConstantExpr::getSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6225 ConstantExpr::getUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
6226
6227 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006228 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006229
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006230 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6231 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6232 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6233 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6234 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6235 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6236 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6237 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
6238 ConstantInt *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
6239
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006240 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006241 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006242 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006243 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6244 if (!HiOverflow)
6245 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006246 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006247 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006248 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006249 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(SubOne(DivRHS)));
6250 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006251 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006252 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6253 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6254 if (!HiOverflow)
6255 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006256 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006257 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006258 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006259 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6260 if (!LoOverflow) {
6261 ConstantInt* DivNeg = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
6262 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg,
6263 true) ? -1 : 0;
6264 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006265 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006266 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006267 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006268 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006269 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS);
6270 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006271 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6272 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6273 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6274 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006275 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006276 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006277 HiBound = AddOne(Prod);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006278 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006279 if (!LoOverflow)
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006280 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivRHS, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006281 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006282 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6283 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006284 if (!HiOverflow)
6285 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006286 }
6287
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006288 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6289 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006290 }
6291
6292 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006293 switch (Pred) {
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006294 default: assert(0 && "Unhandled icmp opcode!");
6295 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6296 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6297 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6298 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006299 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006300 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6301 else if (LoOverflow)
6302 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
6303 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6304 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006305 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006306 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6307 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
6308 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6309 else if (HiOverflow)
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006310 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006311 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6312 else if (LoOverflow)
6313 return new ICmpInst(DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
6314 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6315 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006316 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006317 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6318 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006319 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
6320 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6321 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006322 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006323 return new ICmpInst(Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006324 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6325 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006326 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006327 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006328 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
6329 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6330 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006331 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6332 else
6333 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
6334 }
6335}
6336
6337
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006338/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6339///
6340Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6341 Instruction *LHSI,
6342 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6343 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6344
6345 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006346 case Instruction::Trunc:
6347 if (ICI.isEquality() && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6348 // Simplify icmp eq (trunc x to i8), 42 -> icmp eq x, 42|highbits if all
6349 // of the high bits truncated out of x are known.
6350 unsigned DstBits = LHSI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(),
6351 SrcBits = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6352 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(SrcBits, SrcBits-DstBits));
6353 APInt KnownZero(SrcBits, 0), KnownOne(SrcBits, 0);
6354 ComputeMaskedBits(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6355
6356 // If all the high bits are known, we can do this xform.
6357 if ((KnownZero|KnownOne).countLeadingOnes() >= SrcBits-DstBits) {
6358 // Pull in the high bits from known-ones set.
6359 APInt NewRHS(RHS->getValue());
6360 NewRHS.zext(SrcBits);
6361 NewRHS |= KnownOne;
6362 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6363 ConstantInt::get(NewRHS));
6364 }
6365 }
6366 break;
6367
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006368 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006369 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6370 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6371 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006372 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6373 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006374 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6375
6376 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6377 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6378 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6379 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6380 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6381 return &ICI;
6382 }
6383
6384 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6385 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6386
6387 // If so, the new one isn't.
6388 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6389
6390 if (isTrueIfPositive)
6391 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal, SubOne(RHS));
6392 else
6393 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal, AddOne(RHS));
6394 }
6395 }
6396 break;
6397 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6398 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6399 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6400 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6401
6402 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6403 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6404 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6405 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6406 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6407 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6408 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6409 // bit would not work.
6410 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006411 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6412 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006413 uint32_t BitWidth =
6414 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6415 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6416 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6417 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6418 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6419 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006420 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006421 ConstantInt::get(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
6422 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6423 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
6424 ConstantInt::get(NewCI));
6425 }
6426 }
6427
6428 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6429 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6430 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6431 // access.
6432 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6433 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6434 Shift = 0;
6435
6436 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6437 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6438 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6439 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6440
6441 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6442 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6443 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6444 if (ShAmt) {
6445 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6446 if (!CanFold) {
6447 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6448 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6449 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6450 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6451
6452 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6453 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6454 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6455 CanFold = true;
6456 }
6457
6458 if (CanFold) {
6459 Constant *NewCst;
6460 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6461 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
6462 else
6463 NewCst = ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt);
6464
6465 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6466 // compared.
6467 if (ConstantExpr::get(Shift->getOpcode(), NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
6468 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6469 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6470 // result is always true or false now.
6471 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
6472 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
6473 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
6474 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
6475 } else {
6476 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6477 Constant *NewAndCST;
6478 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
6479 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
6480 else
6481 NewAndCST = ConstantExpr::getShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
6482 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6483 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6484 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6485 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6486 return &ICI;
6487 }
6488 }
6489 }
6490
6491 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6492 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6493 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6494 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
6495 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6496 isa<Instruction>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
6497 // Compute C << Y.
6498 Value *NS;
6499 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006500 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006501 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6502 } else {
6503 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006504 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006505 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6506 }
6507 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6508
6509 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6510 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006511 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006512 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6513
6514 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6515 return &ICI;
6516 }
6517 }
6518 break;
6519
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006520 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6521 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6522 if (!ShAmt) break;
6523
6524 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6525
6526 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6527 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6528 // simplified.
6529 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6530 break;
6531
6532 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6533 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6534 // comparison cannot succeed.
6535 Constant *Comp =
6536 ConstantExpr::getShl(ConstantExpr::getLShr(RHS, ShAmt), ShAmt);
6537 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6538 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6539 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6540 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6541 }
6542
6543 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6544 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6545 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6546 Constant *Mask =
6547 ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006548
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006549 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006550 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006551 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6552 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6553 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6554 ConstantInt::get(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006555 }
6556 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006557
6558 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6559 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6560 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6561 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6562 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
6563 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
6564 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6565 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006566 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006567 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6568 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6569
6570 return new ICmpInst(TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
6571 And, Constant::getNullValue(And->getType()));
6572 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006573 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006574 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006575
6576 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006577 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006578 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006579 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006580 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006581
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006582 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6583 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6584 // simplified.
6585 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6586 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6587 break;
6588
6589 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006590
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006591 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6592 // comparison cannot succeed.
6593 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6594 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6595 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6596 else
6597 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6598
6599 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6600 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6601 Constant *Cst = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
6602 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6603 }
6604
6605 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6606 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6607 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006608 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6609 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006610 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
6611 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
6612 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
6613 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006614
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006615 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006616 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6617 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
6618 Constant *Mask = ConstantInt::get(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006619
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006620 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006621 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006622 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6623 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6624 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), And,
6625 ConstantExpr::getShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006626 }
6627 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006628 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006629
6630 case Instruction::SDiv:
6631 case Instruction::UDiv:
6632 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
6633 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
6634 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
6635 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
6636 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
6637 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006638 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
6639 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
6640 DivRHS))
6641 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006642 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00006643
6644 case Instruction::Add:
6645 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
6646
6647 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
6648 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6649 if (!LHSC) break;
6650 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
6651
6652 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
6653 .subtract(LHSV);
6654
6655 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
6656 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
6657 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6658 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6659 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
6660 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6661 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6662 }
6663 } else {
6664 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
6665 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6666 ConstantInt::get(CR.getUpper()));
6667 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
6668 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
6669 ConstantInt::get(CR.getLower()));
6670 }
6671 }
6672 }
6673 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006674 }
6675
6676 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
6677 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6678 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
6679
6680 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
6681 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
6682 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
6683 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
6684 case Instruction::SRem:
6685 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
6686 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
6687 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
6688 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
6689 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006690 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006691 BO->getName());
6692 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
6693 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
6694 Constant::getNullValue(BO->getType()));
6695 }
6696 }
6697 break;
6698 case Instruction::Add:
6699 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
6700 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6701 if (BO->hasOneUse())
6702 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6703 Subtract(RHS, BOp1C));
6704 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
6705 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
6706 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
6707 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
6708
6709 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1))
6710 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
6711 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0))
6712 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
6713 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006714 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006715 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
6716 Neg->takeName(BO);
6717 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
6718 }
6719 }
6720 break;
6721 case Instruction::Xor:
6722 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
6723 // the explicit xor.
6724 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
6725 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6726 ConstantExpr::getXor(RHS, BOC));
6727
6728 // FALLTHROUGH
6729 case Instruction::Sub:
6730 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
6731 if (RHSV == 0)
6732 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
6733 BO->getOperand(1));
6734 break;
6735
6736 case Instruction::Or:
6737 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
6738 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
6739 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6740 Constant *NotCI = ConstantExpr::getNot(RHS);
6741 if (!ConstantExpr::getAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
6742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6743 isICMP_NE));
6744 }
6745 break;
6746
6747 case Instruction::And:
6748 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
6749 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
6750 // comparison can never succeed!
6751 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
6752 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty,
6753 isICMP_NE));
6754
6755 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
6756 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
6757 return new ICmpInst(isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
6758 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
6759 Constant::getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
6760
6761 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00006762 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006763 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6764 Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(X->getType());
6765 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6766 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
6767 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, Zero);
6768 }
6769
6770 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
6771 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
6772 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
6773 Constant *NegX = ConstantExpr::getNeg(BOC);
6774 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
6775 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
6776 return new ICmpInst(pred, X, NegX);
6777 }
6778 }
6779 default: break;
6780 }
6781 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
6782 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
6783 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
6784 AddToWorkList(II);
6785 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
6786 ICI.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(RHSV.byteSwap()));
6787 return &ICI;
6788 }
6789 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006790 }
6791 return 0;
6792}
6793
6794/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
6795/// We only handle extending casts so far.
6796///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006797Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
6798 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00006799 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
6800 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006801 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006802 Value *RHSCIOp;
6803
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006804 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
6805 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
6806 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
6807 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
6808 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
6809 Value *RHSOp = 0;
6810 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6f6f5122007-05-06 07:24:03 +00006811 RHSOp = ConstantExpr::getIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006812 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
6813 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
6814 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
6815 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006816 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00006817 }
6818
6819 if (RHSOp)
6820 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
6821 }
6822
6823 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
6824 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006825 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
6826 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00006827 return 0;
6828
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006829 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
6830 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006831
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006832 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006833 // Not an extension from the same type?
6834 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006835 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
6836 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006837
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006838 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00006839 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
6840 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
6841 return 0;
6842
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00006843 // Deal with equality cases early.
6844 if (ICI.isEquality())
6845 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6846
6847 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
6848 // signed comparison.
6849 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
6850 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
6851
6852 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
6853 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00006854 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006855
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006856 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
6857 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6858 if (!CI)
6859 return 0;
6860
6861 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
6862 // reextended to DestTy.
6863 Constant *Res1 = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
6864 Constant *Res2 = ConstantExpr::getCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(), Res1, DestTy);
6865
6866 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
6867 if (Res2 == CI) {
6868 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
6869 // For example, we might have:
6870 // %A = sext short %X to uint
6871 // %B = icmp ugt uint %A, 1330
6872 // It is incorrect to transform this into
6873 // %B = icmp ugt short %X, 1330
6874 // because %A may have negative value.
6875 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006876 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
6877 // signless.
6878 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006879 return new ICmpInst(ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006880 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006881 }
6882
6883 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
6884 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
6885
6886 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
6887 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
6888 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006889 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006890 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006891 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantInt::getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006892
6893 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
6894 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
6895 Value *Result;
6896 if (isSignedCmp) {
6897 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00006898 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006899 Result = ConstantInt::getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006900 else
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006901 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006902 } else {
6903 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
6904 if (isSignedExt) {
6905 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
6906 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006907 Constant *NegOne = ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006908 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHSCIOp,
6909 NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
6910 } else {
6911 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00006912 Result = ConstantInt::getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006913 }
6914 }
6915
6916 // Finally, return the value computed.
6917 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006918 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006919 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00006920
6921 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
6922 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
6923 "ICmp should be folded!");
6924 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
6925 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, ConstantExpr::getNot(CI));
6926 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006927}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006928
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006929Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
6930 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6931}
6932
6933Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
6934 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
6935}
6936
6937Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006938 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
6939 return R;
6940
6941 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
6942
6943 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
6944 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
6945 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
6946 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
6947
6948 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
Nate Begeman5bc1ea02008-07-29 15:49:41 +00006949 if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType()) &&
6950 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006951 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006952 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00006953
6954 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006955}
6956
6957Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
6958 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006959 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006960
6961 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
6962 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006963 if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00006964 Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
6965 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006966
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006967 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
6968 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00006969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006970 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006971 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
6972 }
6973 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006974 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
6975 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
6976 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006977 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00006978 }
6979
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006980 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
6981 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
6982 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00006983 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00006984 return R;
6985
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006986 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00006987 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
6988 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006989 return 0;
6990}
6991
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00006992Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00006993 BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006994 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00006995
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00006996 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
6997 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00006998 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6999 APInt KnownZero(TypeBits, 0), KnownOne(TypeBits, 0);
7000 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&I, APInt::getAllOnesValue(TypeBits),
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007001 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7002 return &I;
7003
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007004 // shl uint X, 32 = 0 and shr ubyte Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate shr
7005 // of a signed value.
7006 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007007 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00007008 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007009 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
7010 else {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00007011 I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007012 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00007013 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007014 }
7015
7016 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
7017 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
7018 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
7019 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007020 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007021 ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
7022
7023 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7024 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
7025 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
7026 return R;
7027 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
7028 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
7029 return NV;
7030
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007031 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
7032 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
7033 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
7034 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
7035 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
7036 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
7037 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
7038 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
7039 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
7040 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
7041 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
7042 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007043 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007044 I.getName());
7045 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
7046
7047 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
7048 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
7049 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
7050 // other xforms later if dead.
7051 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7052 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7053 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
7054
7055 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
7056 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
7057 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
7058 // mask as appropriate.
7059 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
7060 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
7061 else {
7062 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
7063 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
7064 }
7065
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007066 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, ConstantInt::get(MaskV),
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007067 TI->getName());
7068 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
7069
7070 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
7071 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
7072 }
7073 }
7074
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007075 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007076 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
7077 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
7078 Value *V1, *V2;
7079 ConstantInt *CC;
7080 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007081 default: break;
7082 case Instruction::Add:
7083 case Instruction::And:
7084 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007085 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007086 // These operators commute.
7087 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007088 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007089 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1), m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)))){
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007090 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007091 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007092 Op0BO->getName());
7093 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007094 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007095 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007096 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007097 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007098 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007099 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007100 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007101 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007102
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007103 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007104 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00007105 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007106 match(Op0BOOp1,
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007107 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)),
7108 m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
7109 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007110 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007111 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
7112 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007113 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7114 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007115 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007116 V1->getName()+".mask");
7117 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7118
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007119 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007120 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007121 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007122
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007123 // FALL THROUGH.
7124 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007125 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007126 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007127 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0), m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)))){
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007128 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007129 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7130 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007131 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007132 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007133 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007134 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007135 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007136 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007137 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007138 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007139 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007140
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007141 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007142 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7143 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7144 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007145 m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007146 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7147 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007148 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007149 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7150 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007151 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7152 Instruction *XM =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007153 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007154 V1->getName()+".mask");
7155 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7156
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007157 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007158 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007159
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007160 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007161 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007162 }
7163
7164
7165 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7166 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7167 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7168 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7169 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7170
7171 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007172 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007173 case Instruction::Add:
7174 isValid = isLeftShift;
7175 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007176 case Instruction::Or:
7177 case Instruction::Xor:
7178 highBitSet = false;
7179 break;
7180 case Instruction::And:
7181 highBitSet = true;
7182 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007183 }
7184
7185 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7186 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7187 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7188 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7189 // operation.
7190 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007191 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007192 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007193
7194 if (isValid) {
7195 Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
7196
7197 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007198 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007199 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007200 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007201
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007202 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007203 NewRHS);
7204 }
7205 }
7206 }
7207 }
7208
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007209 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007210 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7211 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7212 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007213
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007214 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007215 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007216 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7217 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007218 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7219 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7220 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007221
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007222 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00007223 if (AmtSum > TypeBits)
7224 AmtSum = TypeBits;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007225
7226 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7227
7228 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007229 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007230 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007231 ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
7232 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7233 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
7234 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007235 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007236 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7237 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7238 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
7239 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007240 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007241 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7242
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007243 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007244 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007245 }
7246
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007247 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7248 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7249 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7250 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7251 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007252 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007253 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007254 }
7255 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7256 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007257 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007258 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007259 }
7260 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7261 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7262 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7263 // generators.
7264 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7265 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007266 case 1 :
7267 case 8 :
7268 case 16 :
7269 case 32 :
7270 case 64 :
7271 case 128:
7272 SExtType = IntegerType::get(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
7273 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007274 default: break;
7275 }
7276 if (SExtType) {
7277 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7278 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7279 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7280 }
7281 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7282 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007283 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007284
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007285 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007286 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7287 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7288 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007289 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007290 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007291 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7292
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007293 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007294 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007295 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007296
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007297 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007298 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7299 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7300 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007301 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007302 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007303
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007304 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007305 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007306 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007307
7308 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7309 } else {
7310 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007311 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007312
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007313 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007314 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7315 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7316 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7317 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007318 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007319 ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
7320 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7321
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007322 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007323 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007324 }
7325
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007326 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007327 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7328 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7329 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007330 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007331 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7332
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007333 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007334 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, ConstantInt::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007335 }
7336
7337 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007338 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007339 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007340 return 0;
7341}
7342
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007343
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007344/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7345/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7346/// X*Scale+Offset.
7347///
7348static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007349 int &Offset) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007350 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007351 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007352 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007353 Scale = 0;
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007354 return ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007355 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7356 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7357 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7358 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7359 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7360 Offset = 0;
7361 return I->getOperand(0);
7362 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7363 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7364 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7365 Offset = 0;
7366 return I->getOperand(0);
7367 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7368 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7369 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7370 unsigned SubScale;
7371 Value *SubVal =
7372 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale, Offset);
7373 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7374 Scale = SubScale;
7375 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007376 }
7377 }
7378 }
7379
7380 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7381 Scale = 1;
7382 Offset = 0;
7383 return Val;
7384}
7385
7386
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007387/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7388/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007389Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007390 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007391 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007392
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007393 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7394 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007395
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007396 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7397 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7398 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7399 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7400 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7401
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007402 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007403 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007404 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007405 }
7406 }
7407
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007408 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7409 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7410 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7411 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007412
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007413 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7414 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007415 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7416
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007417 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7418 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
7419 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds.
7420 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7421
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00007422 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypePaddedSize(AllocElTy);
7423 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypePaddedSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007424 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007425
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007426 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7427 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007428 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7429 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007430 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
7431 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale, ArrayOffset);
7432
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007433 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7434 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007435 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7436 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007437
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007438 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7439 Value *Amt = 0;
7440 if (Scale == 1) {
7441 Amt = NumElements;
7442 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007443 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007444 Amt = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
7445 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00007446 Amt = Multiply(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements), cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007447 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007448 else if (Scale != 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007449 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007450 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007451 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007452 }
7453
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007454 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
7455 Value *Off = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007456 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007457 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7458 }
7459
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007460 AllocationInst *New;
7461 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007462 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007463 else
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007464 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007465 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007466 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007467
7468 // If the allocation has multiple uses, insert a cast and change all things
7469 // that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it will
7470 // die soon.
7471 if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
7472 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007473 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7474 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7475 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007476 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7477 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7478 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007479 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7480}
7481
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007482/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007483/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7484/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7485/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7486/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7487///
7488/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7489/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007490///
7491/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7492/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7493/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7494/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7495/// efficiently truncated.
7496///
7497/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7498/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7499/// the final result.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00007500bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const IntegerType *Ty,
7501 unsigned CastOpc,
7502 int &NumCastsRemoved) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007503 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
7504 if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
7505 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007506
7507 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007508 if (!I) return false;
7509
7510 const IntegerType *OrigTy = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007511
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007512 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7513 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7514 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7515 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7516 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7517 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7518 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7519 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007520 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007521 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7522 return true;
7523 }
7524 }
7525
7526 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7527 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7528 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7529
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007530 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007531 case Instruction::Add:
7532 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007533 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007534 case Instruction::And:
7535 case Instruction::Or:
7536 case Instruction::Xor:
7537 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007538 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7539 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7540 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7541 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007542
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007543 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007544 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7545 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7546 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007547 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7548 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getBitWidth() &&
7549 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007550 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7551 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007552 }
7553 break;
7554 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007555 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7556 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7557 // already zeros.
7558 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007559 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getBitWidth();
7560 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getBitWidth();
7561 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007562 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007563 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7564 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007565 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7566 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007567 }
7568 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007569 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007570 case Instruction::ZExt:
7571 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007572 case Instruction::Trunc:
7573 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00007574 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
7575 // of casts in the input.
7576 if (I->getOpcode() == CastOpc)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007577 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007578 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007579 case Instruction::Select: {
7580 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
7581 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7582 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7583 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
7584 NumCastsRemoved);
7585 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007586 case Instruction::PHI: {
7587 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
7588 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7589 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
7590 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
7591 NumCastsRemoved))
7592 return false;
7593 return true;
7594 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007595 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007596 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7597 break;
7598 }
7599
7600 return false;
7601}
7602
7603/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
7604/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
7605/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007606Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007607 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007608 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007609 return ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(C, Ty, isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007610
7611 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
7612 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00007613 Instruction *Res = 0;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007614 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007615 case Instruction::Add:
7616 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00007617 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007618 case Instruction::And:
7619 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007620 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007621 case Instruction::AShr:
7622 case Instruction::LShr:
7623 case Instruction::Shl: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007624 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007625 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007626 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)I->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007627 LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007628 break;
7629 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007630 case Instruction::Trunc:
7631 case Instruction::ZExt:
7632 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007633 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007634 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
7635 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007636 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
7637 return I->getOperand(0);
7638
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007639 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007640 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007641 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007642 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007643 case Instruction::Select: {
7644 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
7645 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
7646 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
7647 break;
7648 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007649 case Instruction::PHI: {
7650 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
7651 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
7652 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
7653 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
7654 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
7655 }
7656 Res = NPN;
7657 break;
7658 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007659 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007660 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
7661 assert(0 && "Unreachable!");
7662 break;
7663 }
7664
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007665 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007666 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
7667}
7668
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007669/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
7670Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00007671 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7672
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00007673 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007674 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007675 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007676 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
7677 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
7678 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
7679 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007680 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00007681 }
7682 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00007683
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007684 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007685 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
7686 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
7687 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007688
7689 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00007690 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
7691 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
7692 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00007693
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007694 return 0;
7695}
7696
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007697/// FindElementAtOffset - Given a type and a constant offset, determine whether
7698/// or not there is a sequence of GEP indices into the type that will land us at
7699/// the specified offset. If so, fill them into NewIndices and return true,
7700/// otherwise return false.
7701static bool FindElementAtOffset(const Type *Ty, int64_t Offset,
7702 SmallVectorImpl<Value*> &NewIndices,
7703 const TargetData *TD) {
7704 if (!Ty->isSized()) return false;
7705
7706 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
7707 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
7708 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
7709 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
7710 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00007711 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypePaddedSize(Ty)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007712 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
Chris Lattner31a69cb2009-01-11 20:41:36 +00007713 Offset -= FirstIdx*TySize;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007714
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00007715 // Handle hosts where % returns negative instead of values [0..TySize).
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007716 if (Offset < 0) {
7717 --FirstIdx;
7718 Offset += TySize;
7719 assert(Offset >= 0);
7720 }
7721 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize && "Out of range offset");
7722 }
7723
7724 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
7725
7726 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
7727 while (Offset) {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00007728 // Indexing into tail padding between struct/array elements.
7729 if (uint64_t(Offset*8) >= TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
7730 return false;
7731
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007732 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty)) {
7733 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00007734 assert(Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes() &&
7735 "Offset must stay within the indexed type");
7736
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007737 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
7738 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
7739
7740 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
7741 Ty = STy->getElementType(Elt);
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00007742 } else if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00007743 uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypePaddedSize(AT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00007744 assert(EltSize && "Cannot index into a zero-sized array");
7745 NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
7746 Offset %= EltSize;
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00007747 Ty = AT->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007748 } else {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00007749 // Otherwise, we can't index into the middle of this atomic type, bail.
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007750 return false;
7751 }
7752 }
7753
7754 return true;
7755}
7756
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007757/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
7758Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7759 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7760
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007761 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007762 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
7763 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007764 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
7765 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
7766 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
7767 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007768 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007769 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
7770 return &CI;
7771 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007772
7773 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
7774 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
7775 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
7776 // non-type-safe code.
7777 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
7778 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
7779 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
7780 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
7781 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
7782
7783 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
7784 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
7785 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
7786 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007787 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
7788 if (FindElementAtOffset(GEPIdxTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD)) {
7789 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
7790 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
7791 // two.
7792 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
7793 NewIndices.begin(),
7794 NewIndices.end(), "");
7795 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
7796 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007797
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00007798 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
7799 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
7800 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
7801 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00007802 }
7803 }
7804 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007805 }
7806
7807 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
7808}
7809
7810
7811
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007812/// Only the TRUNC, ZEXT, SEXT, and BITCAST can both operand and result as
7813/// integer types. This function implements the common transforms for all those
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007814/// cases.
7815/// @brief Implement the transforms common to CastInst with integer operands
7816Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
7817 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
7818 return Result;
7819
7820 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7821 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
7822 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007823 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7824 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007825
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007826 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
7827 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00007828 APInt KnownZero(DestBitSize, 0), KnownOne(DestBitSize, 0);
7829 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(&CI, APInt::getAllOnesValue(DestBitSize),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007830 KnownZero, KnownOne))
7831 return &CI;
7832
7833 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
7834 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007835 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
7836 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007837 return 0;
7838
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007839 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007840 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007841 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(CI) &&
7842 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, cast<IntegerType>(DestTy),
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007843 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007844 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007845 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
7846 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
7847 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
7848 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007849 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007850 bool DoXForm;
7851 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7852 default:
7853 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
7854 // get here because of the check above.
7855 assert(0 && "Unknown cast type");
7856 case Instruction::Trunc:
7857 DoXForm = true;
7858 break;
7859 case Instruction::ZExt:
7860 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
7861 break;
7862 case Instruction::SExt:
7863 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
7864 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007865 }
7866
7867 if (DoXForm) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00007868 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
7869 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007870 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
7871 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
7872 default: assert(0 && "Unknown cast type!");
7873 case Instruction::Trunc:
7874 case Instruction::BitCast:
7875 // Just replace this cast with the result.
7876 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
7877 case Instruction::ZExt: {
7878 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
7879 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00007880 Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
7881 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007882 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007883 }
7884 case Instruction::SExt:
7885 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007886 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007887 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
7888 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007889 }
7890 }
7891 }
7892
7893 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
7894 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
7895
7896 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7897 case Instruction::Add:
7898 case Instruction::Mul:
7899 case Instruction::And:
7900 case Instruction::Or:
7901 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007902 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007903 if (DestBitSize <= SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
7904 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7905 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7906 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
7907 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007908 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy,TD) ||
7909 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00007910 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CI.getOpcode();
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00007911 Value *Op0c = InsertCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, *SrcI);
7912 Value *Op1c = InsertCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, *SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007913 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007914 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007915 }
7916 }
7917
7918 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
7919 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
7920 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00007921 Op1 == ConstantInt::getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007922 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00007923 Value *New = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007924 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New, ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007925 }
7926 break;
7927 case Instruction::SDiv:
7928 case Instruction::UDiv:
7929 case Instruction::SRem:
7930 case Instruction::URem:
7931 // If we are just changing the sign, rewrite.
7932 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize) {
7933 // Don't insert two casts if they cannot be eliminated. We allow
7934 // two casts to be inserted if the sizes are the same. This could
7935 // only be converting signedness, which is a noop.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007936 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
7937 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00007938 Value *Op0c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7939 Op0, DestTy, *SrcI);
7940 Value *Op1c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
7941 Op1, DestTy, *SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007942 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007943 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
7944 }
7945 }
7946 break;
7947
7948 case Instruction::Shl:
7949 // Allow changing the sign of the source operand. Do not allow
7950 // changing the size of the shift, UNLESS the shift amount is a
7951 // constant. We must not change variable sized shifts to a smaller
7952 // size, because it is undefined to shift more bits out than exist
7953 // in the value.
7954 if (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ||
7955 (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && isa<Constant>(Op1))) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00007956 Instruction::CastOps opcode = (DestBitSize == SrcBitSize ?
7957 Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc);
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00007958 Value *Op0c = InsertCastBefore(opcode, Op0, DestTy, *SrcI);
7959 Value *Op1c = InsertCastBefore(opcode, Op1, DestTy, *SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007960 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007961 }
7962 break;
7963 case Instruction::AShr:
7964 // If this is a signed shr, and if all bits shifted in are about to be
7965 // truncated off, turn it into an unsigned shr to allow greater
7966 // simplifications.
7967 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
7968 isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007969 uint32_t ShiftAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)->getLimitedValue(SrcBitSize);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007970 if (SrcBitSize > ShiftAmt && SrcBitSize-ShiftAmt >= DestBitSize) {
7971 // Insert the new logical shift right.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007972 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, Op1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007973 }
7974 }
7975 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007976 }
7977 return 0;
7978}
7979
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00007980Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007981 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
7982 return Result;
7983
7984 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
7985 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007986 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
7987 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007988
7989 if (Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src)) {
7990 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
7991 default: break;
7992 case Instruction::LShr:
7993 // We can shrink lshr to something smaller if we know the bits shifted in
7994 // are already zeros.
7995 if (ConstantInt *ShAmtV = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007996 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00007997
7998 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00007999 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008000 Value* SrcIOp0 = SrcI->getOperand(0);
8001 if (SrcI->hasOneUse() && MaskedValueIsZero(SrcIOp0, Mask)) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008002 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
8003 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(Ty));
8004
8005 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
8006 // shift.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008007 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcIOp0, Ty, CI);
8008 Value *V2 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, SrcI->getOperand(1),
8009 Ty, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008010 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008011 }
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00008012 } else { // This is a variable shr.
8013
8014 // Turn 'trunc (lshr X, Y) to bool' into '(X & (1 << Y)) != 0'. This is
8015 // more LLVM instructions, but allows '1 << Y' to be hoisted if
8016 // loop-invariant and CSE'd.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008017 if (CI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty && SrcI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00008018 Value *One = ConstantInt::get(SrcI->getType(), 1);
8019
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008020 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008021 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(One, SrcI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008022 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008023 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V,
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00008024 SrcI->getOperand(0),
8025 "tmp"), CI);
8026 Value *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(V->getType());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008027 return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, Zero);
Chris Lattnere13ab2a2006-12-05 01:26:29 +00008028 }
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008029 }
8030 break;
8031 }
8032 }
8033
8034 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008035}
8036
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008037/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
8038/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
8039Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
8040 bool DoXform) {
8041 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8042 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8043 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8044 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
8045 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
8046
8047 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
8048 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
8049 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8050 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8051 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8052
8053 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8054 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
8055 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008056 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008057 In->getName()+".lobit"),
8058 CI);
8059 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008060 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008061 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
8062
8063 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
8064 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008065 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008066 In->getName()+".not"),
8067 CI);
8068 }
8069
8070 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8071 }
8072
8073
8074
8075 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8076 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8077 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8078 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8079 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8080 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8081 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8082 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8083 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
8084 // This only works for EQ and NE
8085 ICI->isEquality()) {
8086 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
8087 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
8088 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8089 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
8090 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8091
8092 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
8093 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
8094 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8095
8096 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
8097 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
8098 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
8099 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
8100 Constant *Res = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
8101 Res = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Res, CI.getType());
8102 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8103 }
8104
8105 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
8106 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8107 if (ShiftAmt) {
8108 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
8109 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008110 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008111 ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
8112 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
8113 }
8114
8115 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
8116 Constant *One = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008117 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008118 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
8119 }
8120
8121 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
8122 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8123 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008124 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008125 }
8126 }
8127 }
8128
8129 return 0;
8130}
8131
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008132Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008133 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8134 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8135 return Result;
8136
8137 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8138
8139 // If this is a cast of a cast
8140 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008141 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8142 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8143 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8144 if (isa<TruncInst>(CSrc)) {
8145 // Get the sizes of the types involved
8146 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008147 uint32_t SrcSize = A->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8148 uint32_t MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8149 uint32_t DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008150 // If we're actually extending zero bits and the trunc is a no-op
8151 if (MidSize < DstSize && SrcSize == DstSize) {
8152 // Replace both of the casts with an And of the type mask.
Zhou Shenge82fca02007-03-28 09:19:01 +00008153 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Reid Spencerad6676e2007-03-22 20:56:53 +00008154 Constant *AndConst = ConstantInt::get(AndValue);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008155 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008156 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CSrc->getOperand(0), AndConst);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008157 // Unfortunately, if the type changed, we need to cast it back.
8158 if (And->getType() != CI.getType()) {
8159 And->setName(CSrc->getName()+".mask");
8160 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008161 And = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(And, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008162 }
8163 return And;
8164 }
8165 }
8166 }
8167
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008168 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8169 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008170
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008171 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8172 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8173 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8174 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8175 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8176 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8177 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8178 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8179 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
8180 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
8181 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008182 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008183 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008184 }
8185
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008186 return 0;
8187}
8188
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008189Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008190 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8191 return I;
8192
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008193 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8194
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008195 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
8196 if (Src->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
8197 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
8198 ConstantInt::getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
8199 Constant::getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008200
8201 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8202 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
8203 if (getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
8204 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
8205 unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>(Op->getType())->getBitWidth();
8206 unsigned MidBits = cast<IntegerType>(Src->getType())->getBitWidth();
8207 unsigned DestBits = cast<IntegerType>(CI.getType())->getBitWidth();
8208 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8209
8210 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8211 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8212 // bits, it is already ready.
8213 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8214 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8215 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8216 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8217 // bits, just sext from i32.
8218 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8219 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8220 } else {
8221 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8222 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8223 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8224 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8225 }
8226 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008227
8228 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8229 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8230 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8231 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8232 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8233 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8234 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8235 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8236 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8237 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8238 // into:
8239 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8240 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8241 Value *A = 0;
8242 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8243 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
8244 m_ConstantInt(CA))) &&
8245 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8246 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8247 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8248 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8249 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8250 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
8251 Constant *ShAmtV = ConstantInt::get(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
8252 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8253 CI.getName()), CI);
8254 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8255 }
8256 }
8257
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008258 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008259}
8260
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008261/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8262/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008263static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008264 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008265 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008266 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8267 if (!losesInfo)
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008268 return ConstantFP::get(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008269 return 0;
8270}
8271
8272/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8273/// through it until we get the source value.
8274static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V) {
8275 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8276 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
8277 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0));
8278
8279 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8280 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8281 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8282 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8283 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8284 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8285 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008286 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008287 return V;
8288 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8289 return V; // Won't shrink.
Chris Lattner02a260a2008-04-20 00:41:09 +00008290 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008291 return V;
8292 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8293 }
8294
8295 return V;
8296}
8297
8298Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8299 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8300 return I;
8301
8302 // If we have fptrunc(add (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
8303 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
8304 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to add/sub/mul/div as well as
8305 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8306 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8307 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8308 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8309 default: break;
8310 case Instruction::Add:
8311 case Instruction::Sub:
8312 case Instruction::Mul:
8313 case Instruction::FDiv:
8314 case Instruction::FRem:
8315 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
8316 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0));
8317 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1));
8318 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8319 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
8320 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
8321 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8322 // the cast, do this xform.
8323 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8324 RHSTrunc->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
8325 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8326 CI.getType(), CI);
8327 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8328 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008329 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008330 }
8331 }
8332 break;
8333 }
8334 }
8335 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008336}
8337
8338Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8339 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8340}
8341
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008342Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008343 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8344 if (OpI == 0)
8345 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8346
8347 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8348 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8349 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8350 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8351 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8352 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8353 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8354 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8355 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
8356 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008358
8359 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008360}
8361
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008362Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008363 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8364 if (OpI == 0)
8365 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8366
8367 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8368 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8369 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8370 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8371 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8372 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8373 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8374 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
8375 (int)FI.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <=
8376 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8377 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008378
8379 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008380}
8381
8382Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8383 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8384}
8385
8386Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8387 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8388}
8389
8390Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008391 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008392}
8393
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008394Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
8395 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8396 return I;
8397
8398 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8399 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8400
8401 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8402 ConstantInt *Cst;
8403 Value *X;
8404 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
8405 m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8406 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8407 // is a single-index GEP.
8408 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8409 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00008410 uint64_t Size = TD->getTypePaddedSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008411
8412 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8413 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8414 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8415
8416 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8417 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8418 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008419 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, ConstantInt::get(Offset));
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008420 }
8421 }
8422 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8423 // struct etc.
8424 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
8425 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(Cst)))) {
8426 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8427 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8428
8429 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00008430 uint64_t Size = TD->getTypePaddedSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008431
8432 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8433 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8434 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8435
8436 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8437 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8438 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8439
8440 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8441 "tmp"), CI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008442 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, ConstantInt::get(Offset), "tmp");
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008443 }
8444 }
8445 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008446}
8447
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008448Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008449 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8450 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8451 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8452 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8453 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8454
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00008455 if (SrcTy->isInteger() && DestTy->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008456 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8457 return Result;
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008458 } else if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
8459 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8460 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008461 } else {
8462 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8463 return Result;
8464 }
8465
8466
8467 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8468 // be replaced by the operand.
8469 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8470 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8471
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008472 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008473 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8474 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8475 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8476
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008477 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8478 // required for changing types.
8479 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8480 return 0;
8481
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008482 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8483 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8484 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8485 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8486 return V;
8487
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008488 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8489 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008490 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
8491 Constant *ZeroUInt = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
8492 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8493 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8494 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8495 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8496 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8497 ++NumZeros;
8498 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008499
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008500 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8501 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8502 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008503 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8504 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008505 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008506 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008507
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008508 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
8509 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
8510 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
8511 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00008512 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00008513 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
8514 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
8515 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
8516 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008517 CastInst *Tmp;
8518 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
8519 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
8520 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
8521 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
8522 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
8523 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
8524 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00008525 Value *LHS = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8526 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, CI);
8527 Value *RHS = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
8528 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008529 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
8530 // know the vector types match #elts.
8531 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00008532 }
8533 }
8534 }
8535 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00008536 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00008537}
8538
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008539/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
8540/// %C = or %A, %B
8541/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
8542/// into:
8543/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
8544/// %D = or %A, %C
8545///
8546/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
8547/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
8548/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
8549///
8550static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
8551 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8552 case Instruction::Add:
8553 case Instruction::Mul:
8554 case Instruction::And:
8555 case Instruction::Or:
8556 case Instruction::Xor:
8557 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
8558 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
8559 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008560 case Instruction::LShr:
8561 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008562 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008563 default:
8564 return 0; // Cannot fold
8565 }
8566}
8567
8568/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
8569/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
8570static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
8571 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
8572 default: assert(0 && "This cannot happen!"); abort();
8573 case Instruction::Add:
8574 case Instruction::Sub:
8575 case Instruction::Or:
8576 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008577 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00008578 case Instruction::LShr:
8579 case Instruction::AShr:
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008580 return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008581 case Instruction::And:
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00008582 return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00008583 case Instruction::Mul:
8584 return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
8585 }
8586}
8587
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008588/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
8589/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
8590Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
8591 Instruction *FI) {
8592 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
8593 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
8594 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008595 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008596 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
8597 return 0;
8598 } else {
8599 return 0; // unknown unary op.
8600 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008601
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008602 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008603 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
8604 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008605 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008606 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008607 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008608 }
8609
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008610 // Only handle binary operators here.
8611 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008612 return 0;
8613
8614 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
8615 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
8616 bool MatchIsOpZero;
8617 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8618 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8619 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8620 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8621 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8622 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8623 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8624 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8625 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8626 MatchIsOpZero = false;
8627 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
8628 return 0;
8629 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
8630 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
8631 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
8632 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
8633 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8634 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
8635 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
8636 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
8637 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
8638 MatchIsOpZero = true;
8639 } else {
8640 return 0;
8641 }
8642
8643 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008644 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
8645 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008646 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
8647
8648 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
8649 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008650 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008651 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008652 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008653 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00008654 assert(0 && "Shouldn't get here");
8655 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008656}
8657
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008658/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
8659/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
8660///
8661Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
8662 ICmpInst *ICI) {
8663 bool Changed = false;
8664 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
8665 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
8666 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
8667 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8668 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8669
8670 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
8671 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
8672 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
8673 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008674 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008675 switch (Pred) {
8676 default: break;
8677 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
8678 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
8679 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
8680 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
8681 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8682 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
8683 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
8684 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8685 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8686 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8687 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8688 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8689 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8690 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8691 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8692 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8693 Changed = true;
8694 }
8695 break;
8696 }
8697 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
8698 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
8699 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
8700 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
8701 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8702 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
8703 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
8704 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
8705 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
8706 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
8707 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
8708 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
8709 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
8710 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
8711 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
8712 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
8713 Changed = true;
8714 }
8715 break;
8716 }
8717 }
8718
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008719 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
8720 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00008721 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Chris Lattner159c35b2009-01-05 23:53:12 +00008722 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()) &&
8723 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00008724 Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
Chris Lattner159c35b2009-01-05 23:53:12 +00008725 else if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()) &&
8726 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00008727 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
8728
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008729 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
8730 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8731 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8732 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8733 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
8734
8735 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
8736 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
8737 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00008738 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008739 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8740 Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
8741 In->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
8742 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
8743 In->getName()+".lobit"),
8744 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00008745 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
8746 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008747 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
8748
8749 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
8750 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
8751 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
8752
8753 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
8754 }
8755 }
8756 }
8757
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008758 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
8759 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
8760 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8761 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8762 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
8763 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8764 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8765 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8766
8767 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
8768 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
8769 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
8770 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8771 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
8772 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
8773 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8774 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
8775 }
8776
8777 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
8778
8779 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
8780}
8781
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00008782Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008783 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
8784 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
8785 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
8786
8787 // select true, X, Y -> X
8788 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008789 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008791
8792 // select C, X, X -> X
8793 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
8794 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8795
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00008796 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
8797 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8798 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
8799 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8800 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
8801 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
8802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
8803 else
8804 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8805 }
8806
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00008807 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008808 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008809 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008810 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008811 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008812 } else {
8813 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
8814 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008815 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008816 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008817 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008818 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00008819 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00008820 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008821 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008822 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008823 } else {
8824 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
8825 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008826 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008827 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008828 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008829 }
8830 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008831
8832 // select a, b, a -> a&b
8833 // select a, a, b -> a|b
8834 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008835 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00008836 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008837 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00008838 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00008839
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008840 // Selecting between two integer constants?
8841 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
8842 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008843 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008844 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008845 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008846 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008847 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00008848 Value *NotCond =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008849 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008850 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008851 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00008852 }
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008853
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008854 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008855
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008856 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008857 if (TrueValC->isAllOnesValue() && FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008858 if (ConstantInt *CmpCst = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008859 if (IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && CmpCst->isZero()) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008860 // The comparison constant and the result are not neccessarily the
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008861 // same width. Make an all-ones value by inserting a AShr.
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008862 Value *X = IC->getOperand(0);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00008863 uint32_t Bits = X->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008864 Constant *ShAmt = ConstantInt::get(X->getType(), Bits-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008865 Instruction *SRA = BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, X,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00008866 ShAmt, "ones");
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008867 InsertNewInstBefore(SRA, SI);
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00008868
8869 // Then cast to the appropriate width.
8870 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(SRA, SI.getType(), true);
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008871 }
8872 }
8873
8874
8875 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008876 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008877 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
8878 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008879 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00008880 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008881 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
8882 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
8883 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008884 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
8885 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
8886 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008887 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
8888 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008889 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
8890 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00008891 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008892 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008893 Value *V = ICA;
8894 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008895 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00008896 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
8897 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
8898 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00008899 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00008900 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008901
8902 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008903 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
8904 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008905 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008906 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8907 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8908 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8909 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8910 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8911 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8912 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8913 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8914 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008915 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008916 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008917 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008918 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008919 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008920 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008921
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008922 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008923 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00008924 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
8925 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
8926 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
8927 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
8928 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
8929 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
8930 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
8931 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
8932 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
8933 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
8934 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00008935 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008936 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
8937 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008938 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008939 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008940 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008941 }
8942
8943 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00008944 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
8945 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
8946 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00008947
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008948 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
8949 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
8950 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008951 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
8952
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00008953 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
8954 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
8955 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
8956 return IV;
8957
8958 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
8959 // even legal for FP.
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008960 if (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8961 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8962 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
8963 } else if (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
8964 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
8965 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
8966 }
8967
8968 if (AddOp) {
8969 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
8970 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
8971 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
8972 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
8973 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
8974 }
8975
8976 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008977 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
8978 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
8979 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
8980 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
8981 NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
8982 } else {
8983 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008984 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1), "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008985 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008986
8987 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
8988 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
8989 if (AddOp != TI)
8990 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
8991 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00008992 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
8993 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00008994
8995 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008996 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00008997 }
8998 }
8999 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009000
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009001 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00009002 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009003 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
9004 // transformation we are doing here.
9005 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
9006 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9007 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal))
9008 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
9009 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9010 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
9011 OpToFold = 1;
9012 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
9013 OpToFold = 2;
9014 }
9015
9016 if (OpToFold) {
9017 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009018 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009019 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(),
9020 TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold), C);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009021 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009022 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009023 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009024 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009025 else {
9026 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
9027 }
9028 }
9029 }
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00009030
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009031 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
9032 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9033 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
9034 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
9035 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9036 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
9037 OpToFold = 1;
9038 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
9039 OpToFold = 2;
9040 }
9041
9042 if (OpToFold) {
9043 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009044 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009045 SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C,
9046 FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold));
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009047 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009048 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009049 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009050 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009051 else
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009052 assert(0 && "Unknown instruction!!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009053 }
9054 }
9055 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00009056
9057 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
9058 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
9059 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
9060 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
9061 return &SI;
9062 }
9063
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009064 return 0;
9065}
9066
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009067/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
9068/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
9069/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
9070/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
9071/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
9072///
9073static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9074 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009075
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009076 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
9077 if (!U) return Align;
9078
9079 switch (getOpcode(U)) {
9080 default: break;
9081 case Instruction::BitCast:
9082 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
9083 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009084 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
9085 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00009086 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009087 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
9088 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009089 AllZeroOperands = false;
9090 break;
9091 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009092
9093 if (AllZeroOperands) {
9094 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009095 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009096 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009097 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009098 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009099 }
9100
9101 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
9102 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
9103 // of the global.
9104 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
9105 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9106 Align = PrefAlign;
9107 }
9108 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
9109 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
9110 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
9111 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
9112 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9113 Align = PrefAlign;
9114 }
9115 }
9116
9117 return Align;
9118}
9119
9120/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
9121/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
9122/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
9123/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
9124unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9125 unsigned PrefAlign) {
9126 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
9127 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
9128 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9129 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9130 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9131 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9132 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9133
9134 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9135 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9136
9137 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9138 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009139}
9140
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009141Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009142 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
9143 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009144 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
9145 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9146
9147 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
9148 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, MinAlign));
9149 return MI;
9150 }
9151
9152 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9153 // load/store.
9154 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9155 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9156
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009157 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9158 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9159 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9160 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009161 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009162 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9163
9164 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009165 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009166
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009167 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009168 Type *NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009169
9170 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9171 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9172 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9173 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9174 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9175 // integer datatype.
9176 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9177 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
9178 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
9179 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9180 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009181 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009182 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9183 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9184 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9185 else
9186 break;
9187 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9188 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9189 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9190 else
9191 break;
9192 } else
9193 break;
9194 }
9195
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009196 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009197 NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
9198 }
9199 }
9200
9201
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009202 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9203 // infer, use it.
9204 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9205 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9206
9207 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
9208 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009209 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9210 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9211 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9212
9213 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9214 MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
9215 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009216}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009217
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009218Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9219 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
9220 if (MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue() < Alignment) {
9221 MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Alignment));
9222 return MI;
9223 }
9224
9225 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9226 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9227 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
9228 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
9229 return 0;
9230 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
9231 Alignment = MI->getAlignment()->getZExtValue();
9232
9233 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9234 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9235
9236 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9237 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
9238 const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
9239
9240 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
9241 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy), *MI);
9242
9243 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9244 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9245
9246 // Extract the fill value and store.
9247 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
9248 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill), Dest, false,
9249 Alignment), *MI);
9250
9251 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
9252 MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
9253 return MI;
9254 }
9255
9256 return 0;
9257}
9258
9259
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009260/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9261/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9262/// the heavy lifting.
9263///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009264Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009265 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9266 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9267
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009268 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9269 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009270 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009271 bool Changed = false;
9272
9273 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9274 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9275 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9276
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009277 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009278 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009279 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9280 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9281 // alignment is sufficient.
9282 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009283 }
9284
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009285 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9286 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9287 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009288 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009289 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9290 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9291 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00009292 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy;
9293 const Type *Tys[1];
9294 Tys[0] = CI.getOperand(3)->getType();
9295 CI.setOperand(0,
9296 Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID, Tys, 1));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009297 Changed = true;
9298 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009299
9300 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9301 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9302 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009303 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009304
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009305 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9306 // set, update the alignment.
9307 if (isa<MemCpyInst>(MI) || isa<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009308 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9309 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009310 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9311 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9312 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009313 }
9314
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009315 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009316 }
9317
9318 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9319 default: break;
9320 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9321 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9322 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9323 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9324 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9325 break;
9326 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9327 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9328 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9329 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9330 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9331 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9332 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9333 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9334 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
9335 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()),
9336 CI);
9337 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009338 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009339 break;
9340 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9341 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9342 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9343 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9344 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9345 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
9346 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9347 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9348 }
9349 break;
9350 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9351 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9352 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009353 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9354 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9355 const Type *OpPtrTy =
9356 PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
9357 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9358 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9359 }
9360 break;
9361
9362 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9363 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9364 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
9365 uint64_t UndefElts;
9366 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), 1,
9367 UndefElts)) {
9368 II->setOperand(1, V);
9369 return II;
9370 }
9371 break;
9372 }
9373
9374 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9375 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9376 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9377 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009378
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009379 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9380 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9381 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9382 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9383 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9384 AllEltsOk = false;
9385 break;
9386 }
9387 }
9388
9389 if (AllEltsOk) {
9390 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9391 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9392 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
9393 Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009394
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009395 // Only extract each element once.
9396 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9397 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9398
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009399 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009400 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9401 continue;
9402 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9403 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9404
9405 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9406 Instruction *Elt =
9407 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1, Idx&15, "tmp");
9408 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9409 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009410 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009411
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009412 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9413 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
9414 i, "tmp");
9415 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009416 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009417 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009418 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009419 }
9420 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009421
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009422 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9423 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9424 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9425 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9426 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9427 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9428 if (&*++BI == II)
9429 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009430 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009431 }
9432
9433 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9434 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9435 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9436 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9437 bool CannotRemove = false;
9438 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9439 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9440 CannotRemove = true;
9441 break;
9442 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009443 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9444 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9445 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9446 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9447 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9448 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9449 } else {
9450 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9451 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009452 CannotRemove = true;
9453 break;
9454 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009455 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009456 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009457
9458 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
9459 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
9460 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
9461 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9462 break;
9463 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009464 }
9465
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009466 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009467}
9468
9469// InvokeInst simplification
9470//
9471Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009472 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009473}
9474
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +00009475/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
9476/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009477static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
9478 const CastInst * const CI,
9479 const TargetData * const TD,
9480 const int ix) {
9481 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
9482 return false;
9483
9484 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
9485 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
9486 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009487 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009488 return true;
9489
9490 const Type* SrcTy =
9491 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
9492 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
9493 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
9494 return false;
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +00009495 if (TD->getTypePaddedSize(SrcTy) != TD->getTypePaddedSize(DstTy))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009496 return false;
9497 return true;
9498}
9499
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009500// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
9501//
9502Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009503 bool Changed = false;
9504
9505 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
9506 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009507 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
9508
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009509 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009510
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009511 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
9512 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
9513 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
9514 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
9515 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009516 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009517 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
9518 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +00009519 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
9520 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
9521 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
9522 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
9523 return 0;
9524 }
9525
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009526 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
9527 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
9528 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
9529 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009530 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009531 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009532 CS.getInstruction());
9533
9534 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
9535 CS.getInstruction()->
9536 replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
9537
9538 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
9539 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009540 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9541 ConstantInt::getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009542 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +00009543 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
9544 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009545
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009546 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
9547 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
9548 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
9549 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
9550
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009551 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9552 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
9553 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +00009554 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009555 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
9556 // the call.
9557 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009558 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
9559 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
9560 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
9561 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
9562 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009563 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +00009564 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009565 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009566
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009567 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009568 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +00009569 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +00009570 Changed = true;
9571 }
9572
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +00009573 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +00009574}
9575
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009576// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
9577// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
9578//
9579bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
9580 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
9581 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009582 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
9583 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009584 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +00009585 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009586 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009587 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009588
9589 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
9590 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
9591 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
9592 //
9593 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
9594 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009595 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009596
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009597 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +00009598 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
9599
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009600 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009601 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +00009602 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009603 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
9604 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
9605 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +00009606 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009607 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009608
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009609 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009610 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009611 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009612 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
9613
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009614 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009615 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009616 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +00009617 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
9618 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009619
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009620 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
9621 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
9622 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
9623 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
9624 if (!Caller->use_empty())
9625 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
9626 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
9627 UI != E; ++UI)
9628 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
9629 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +00009630 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +00009631 return false;
9632 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009633
9634 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
9635 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009636
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009637 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
9638 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
9639 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +00009640 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009641
9642 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009643 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
9644
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009645 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
9646 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009647 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009648
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009649 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
9650 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +00009651 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009652 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
9653 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009654 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009655 }
9656
9657 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +00009658 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009659 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009660
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009661 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
9662 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009663 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009664 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
9665 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009666 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
9667 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009668 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +00009669 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009670 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009671 return false;
9672 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009673
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009674 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
9675 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
9676 std::vector<Value*> Args;
9677 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009678 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009679 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
9680
9681 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009682 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009683
9684 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
9685 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009686 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009687
9688 // Add the new return attributes.
9689 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009690 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009691
9692 AI = CS.arg_begin();
9693 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9694 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
9695 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
9696 Args.push_back(*AI);
9697 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +00009698 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009699 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009700 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009701 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009702 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009703
9704 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009705 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009706 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009707 }
9708
9709 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
9710 // now...
9711 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
9712 Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
9713
9714 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009715 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009716 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +00009717 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
9718 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009719 } else {
9720 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
9721 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
9722 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
9723 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
9724 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009725 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
9726 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009727 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009728 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
9729 Args.push_back(Cast);
9730 } else {
9731 Args.push_back(*AI);
9732 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009733
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009734 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009735 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009736 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +00009737 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009738 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00009739 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009740
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009741 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
9742 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
9743
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +00009744 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009745 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009746
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009747 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +00009748
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009749 Instruction *NC;
9750 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009751 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009752 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9753 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +00009754 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009755 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009756 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009757 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
9758 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009759 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
9760 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +00009761 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009762 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009763 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009764 }
9765
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00009766 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009767 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009768 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009769 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00009770 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +00009771 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009772 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009773
9774 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
9775 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
9776 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +00009777 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +00009778 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
9779 } else {
9780 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
9781 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
9782 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009783 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009784 } else {
Chris Lattnerc30bda72004-10-17 21:22:38 +00009785 NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009786 }
9787 }
9788
9789 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9790 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00009791 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00009792 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009793 return true;
9794}
9795
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009796// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
9797// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
9798//
9799Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
9800 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
9801 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
9802 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009803 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009804
9805 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
9806 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009807 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009808 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009809
9810 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
9811 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
9812
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +00009813 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009814 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
9815 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
9816
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009817 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009818 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009819 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
9820 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009821 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009822
9823 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
9824 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
9825 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009826 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009827 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
9828 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009829 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009830 break;
9831 }
9832
9833 if (NestTy) {
9834 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
9835 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
9836 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
9837
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009838 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +00009839 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009840
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009841 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009842 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
9843
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009844 // Add any result attributes.
9845 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009846 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009847
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009848 {
9849 unsigned Idx = 1;
9850 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
9851 do {
9852 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009853 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009854 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
9855 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
9856 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
9857 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009858 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009859 }
9860
9861 if (I == E)
9862 break;
9863
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009864 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009865 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009866 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009867 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009868 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009869
9870 ++Idx, ++I;
9871 } while (1);
9872 }
9873
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +00009874 // Add any function attributes.
9875 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
9876 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
9877
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009878 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
9879 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009880 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009881
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009882 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009883 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
9884
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009885 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009886 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009887 {
9888 unsigned Idx = 1;
9889 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
9890 E = FTy->param_end();
9891
9892 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009893 if (Idx == NestIdx)
9894 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009895 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009896
9897 if (I == E)
9898 break;
9899
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +00009900 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009901 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009902
9903 ++Idx, ++I;
9904 } while (1);
9905 }
9906
9907 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
9908 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9909 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +00009910 FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes, FTy->isVarArg());
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00009911 Constant *NewCallee = NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
9912 NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009913 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009914
9915 Instruction *NewCaller;
9916 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009917 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
9918 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
9919 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9920 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009921 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009922 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009923 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009924 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
9925 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009926 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
9927 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
9928 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
9929 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +00009930 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +00009931 }
9932 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
9933 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
9934 Caller->eraseFromParent();
9935 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
9936 return 0;
9937 }
9938 }
9939
9940 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
9941 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
9942 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
9943 Constant *NewCallee =
9944 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
9945 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
9946 return CS.getInstruction();
9947}
9948
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009949/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
9950/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
9951/// and a single binop.
9952Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
9953 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +00009954 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009955 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009956 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
9957 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
9958
9959 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
9960 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009961
9962 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
9963 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +00009964 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009965 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +00009966 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009967 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009968 // types or GEP's with different index types.
9969 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
9970 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009971 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009972
9973 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
9974 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
9975 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
9976 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
9977 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009978
9979 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
9980 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
9981 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009982 }
9983
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +00009984 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform!
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009985
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009986 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +00009987 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +00009988 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009989 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009990 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
9991 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009992 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
9993 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +00009994 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
9995 LHSVal = NewLHS;
9996 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +00009997
9998 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009999 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
10000 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010001 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10002 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010003 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
10004 RHSVal = NewRHS;
10005 }
10006
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010007 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010008 if (NewLHS || NewRHS) {
10009 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10010 Instruction *InInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10011 if (NewLHS) {
10012 Value *NewInLHS = InInst->getOperand(0);
10013 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10014 }
10015 if (NewRHS) {
10016 Value *NewInRHS = InInst->getOperand(1);
10017 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10018 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010019 }
10020 }
10021
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010022 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010023 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010024 CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
10025 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(), LHSVal,
10026 RHSVal);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010027}
10028
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010029Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10030 GetElementPtrInst *FirstInst =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10031
10032 SmallVector<Value*, 16> FixedOperands(FirstInst->op_begin(),
10033 FirstInst->op_end());
10034
10035 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
10036 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
10037 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
10038 GetElementPtrInst *GEP= dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10039 if (!GEP || !GEP->hasOneUse() || GEP->getType() != FirstInst->getType() ||
10040 GEP->getNumOperands() != FirstInst->getNumOperands())
10041 return 0;
10042
10043 // Compare the operand lists.
10044 for (unsigned op = 0, e = FirstInst->getNumOperands(); op != e; ++op) {
10045 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op) == GEP->getOperand(op))
10046 continue;
10047
10048 // Don't merge two GEPs when two operands differ (introducing phi nodes)
10049 // if one of the PHIs has a constant for the index. The index may be
10050 // substantially cheaper to compute for the constants, so making it a
10051 // variable index could pessimize the path. This also handles the case
10052 // for struct indices, which must always be constant.
10053 if (isa<ConstantInt>(FirstInst->getOperand(op)) ||
10054 isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(op)))
10055 return 0;
10056
10057 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op)->getType() !=GEP->getOperand(op)->getType())
10058 return 0;
10059 FixedOperands[op] = 0; // Needs a PHI.
10060 }
10061 }
10062
10063 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform. Insert PHI nodes for each operand
10064 // that is variable.
10065 SmallVector<PHINode*, 16> OperandPhis(FixedOperands.size());
10066
10067 bool HasAnyPHIs = false;
10068 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FixedOperands.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10069 if (FixedOperands[i]) continue; // operand doesn't need a phi.
10070 Value *FirstOp = FirstInst->getOperand(i);
10071 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstOp->getType(),
10072 FirstOp->getName()+".pn");
10073 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10074
10075 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(e);
10076 NewPN->addIncoming(FirstOp, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
10077 OperandPhis[i] = NewPN;
10078 FixedOperands[i] = NewPN;
10079 HasAnyPHIs = true;
10080 }
10081
10082
10083 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
10084 if (HasAnyPHIs) {
10085 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10086 GetElementPtrInst *InGEP =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10087 BasicBlock *InBB = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
10088
10089 for (unsigned op = 0, e = OperandPhis.size(); op != e; ++op)
10090 if (PHINode *OpPhi = OperandPhis[op])
10091 OpPhi->addIncoming(InGEP->getOperand(op), InBB);
10092 }
10093 }
10094
10095 Value *Base = FixedOperands[0];
10096 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
10097 FixedOperands.end());
10098}
10099
10100
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010101/// isSafeToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe sink the load out
10102/// of the block that defines it. This means that it must be obvious the value
10103/// of the load is not changed from the point of the load to the end of the
10104/// block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010105///
10106/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
10107/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
10108/// to a register.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010109static bool isSafeToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
10110 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
10111
10112 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
10113 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10114 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010115
10116 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
10117 // profitable to do this xform.
10118 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
10119 bool isAddressTaken = false;
10120 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
10121 UI != E; ++UI) {
10122 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
10123 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
10124 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
10125 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
10126 }
10127 isAddressTaken = true;
10128 break;
10129 }
10130
10131 if (!isAddressTaken)
10132 return false;
10133 }
10134
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010135 return true;
10136}
10137
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010138
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010139// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
10140// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
10141// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
10142Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10143 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10144
10145 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
10146 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
10147 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
10148 // code size and simplifying code.
10149 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
10150 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010151 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010152 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
10153 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +000010154 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010155 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
10156 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010157 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010158 if (ConstantOp == 0)
10159 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010160 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
10161 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
10162 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
10163 // load and the PHI.
10164 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
10165 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
10166 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010167
10168 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10169 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10170 // the path through the other successor.
10171 if (isVolatile &&
10172 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10173 return 0;
10174
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010175 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010176 return FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010177 } else {
10178 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
10179 }
10180
10181 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
10182 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10183 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
10184 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010185 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010186 return 0;
10187 if (CastSrcTy) {
10188 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10189 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010190 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010191 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10192 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010193 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10194 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
10195 !isSafeToSinkLoad(LI))
10196 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010197
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010198 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10199 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10200 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010201 if (isVolatile &&
10202 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10203 return 0;
10204
10205
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010206 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10207 return 0;
10208 }
10209 }
10210
10211 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10212 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010213 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10214 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010215 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010216
10217 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10218 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010219
10220 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010221 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10222 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10223 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10224 InVal = 0;
10225 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10226 }
10227
10228 Value *PhiVal;
10229 if (InVal) {
10230 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10231 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10232 PhiVal = InVal;
10233 delete NewPN;
10234 } else {
10235 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10236 PhiVal = NewPN;
10237 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010238
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010239 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010240 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010241 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010242 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010243 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010244 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010245 return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010246 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010247 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10248
10249 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10250 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10251 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10252 if (isVolatile)
10253 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10254 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10255
10256 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010257}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010258
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010259/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10260/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010261static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10262 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010263 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10264 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10265
10266 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010267 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010268 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010269
10270 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10271 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10272 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010273
10274 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10275 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010276
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010277 return false;
10278}
10279
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010280/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10281/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10282/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10283static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10284 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10285 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10286 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10287 return true;
10288
10289 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10290 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10291 return false;
10292
10293 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10294 // the value.
10295 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10296 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10297 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10298 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10299 return false;
10300 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10301 return false;
10302 }
10303
10304 return true;
10305}
10306
10307
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010308// PHINode simplification
10309//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010310Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010311 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010312 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010313
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010314 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10315 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10316
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010317 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10318 // reducing code size.
10319 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010320 isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1)) &&
10321 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0))->getOpcode() ==
10322 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1))->getOpcode() &&
10323 // FIXME: The hasOneUse check will fail for PHIs that use the value more
10324 // than themselves more than once.
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010325 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10326 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10327 return Result;
10328
10329 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10330 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10331 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010332 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10333 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10334 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010335 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010336 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10337 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
10338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10339 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010340
10341 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10342 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10343 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10344 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10345 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10346 // late.
10347 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10348 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10349 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
10350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
10351 }
10352 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010353
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010354 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10355 // same value, for example:
10356 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10357 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10358 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10359 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10360 {
10361 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10362 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10363 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10364 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10365 ++InValNo;
10366
10367 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10368 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10369
10370 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10371 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10372 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10373 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10374 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10375 break;
10376 }
10377
10378 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10379 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10380 // the value.
10381 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10382 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10383 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10385 }
10386 }
10387 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010388 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010389}
10390
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010391static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10392 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10393 InstCombiner *IC) {
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +000010394 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10395 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010396 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10397 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10398 // used for address computation.
10399 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10400 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10401 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10402 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010403}
10404
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010405
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010406Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010407 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +000010408 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010409 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010410 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010412
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010413 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
10414 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
10415
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010416 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10417 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10418 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10419
10420 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010421 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010422
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010423 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
10424 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010425
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010426 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010427 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
10428 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010429 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010430 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000010431 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
10432 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
10433 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
10434 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
10435 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
10436 if (SrcTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10437 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010438 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010439 }
10440 }
10441 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010442 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010443 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
10444 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010445 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
10446 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010447 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010448 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010449 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010450 *i = ConstantExpr::getTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000010451 MadeChange = true;
10452 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010453 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10454 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000010455 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000010456 MadeChange = true;
10457 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000010458 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
10459 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
10460 *i = ConstantExpr::getSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
10461 MadeChange = true;
10462 } else {
10463 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
10464 GEP);
10465 *i = Op;
10466 MadeChange = true;
10467 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010468 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010469 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000010470 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010471 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
10472
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010473 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
10474 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
10475 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
10476 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010477 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000010478 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010479 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010480
10481 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010482 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
10483 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
10484 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
10485 //
10486 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
10487 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
10488 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
10489
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000010490 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010491
10492 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
10493 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
10494 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
10495 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000010496 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010497
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010498 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010499 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000010500 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
10501 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
10502 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010503 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010504 if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
10505 Sum = GO1;
10506 } else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
10507 Sum = SO1;
10508 } else {
10509 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
10510 // target's pointer size.
10511 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
10512 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010513 SO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010514 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010515 GO1 = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010516 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010517 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
10518 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010519 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010520 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010521
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000010522 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010523 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010524 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010525 } else {
10526 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010527 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
10528 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010529 }
10530 }
10531 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010532 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
10533 Sum = ConstantExpr::getAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1), cast<Constant>(GO1));
10534 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010535 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000010536 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010537 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010538 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010539
10540 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
10541 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
10542 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
10543 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
10544 return &GEP;
10545 } else {
10546 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10547 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
10548 Indices.push_back(Sum);
10549 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
10550 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010551 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010552 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010553 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010554 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000010555 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
10556 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000010557 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
10558 }
10559
10560 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010561 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
10562 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010563
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010564 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010565 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
10566 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
10567
10568 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010569 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010570 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
10571 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
10572 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
10573
10574 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010575 Constant *CE = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(GV,
10576 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000010577
10578 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
10579 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
10580 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010581 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010582 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
10583 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
10584 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010585 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
10586 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010587 //
10588 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
10589 //
10590 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
10591 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
10592 if (const ArrayType *XATy =
10593 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType()))
10594 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
10595 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType()))
10596 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
10597 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
10598 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
10599 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
10600 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
10601 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
10602 return &GEP;
10603 }
10604 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
10605 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010606 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
10607 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010608 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
10609 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
10610 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +000010611 TD->getTypePaddedSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
10612 TD->getTypePaddedSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010613 Value *Idx[2];
10614 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10615 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000010616 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010617 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010618 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
10619 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010620 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010621
10622 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010623 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010624 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010625 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010626
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010627 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010628 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +000010629 TD->getTypePaddedSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010630
10631 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
10632 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
10633 Value *NewIdx = 0;
10634 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
10635 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
10636 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
10637 Scale = ConstantInt::get(NewIdx->getType(), 1);
10638 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner6e2f8432005-09-14 17:32:56 +000010639 NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010640 Scale = CI;
10641 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
10642 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
10643 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000010644 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10645 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
10646 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Inst->getType(), 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010647 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10648 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
10649 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
10650 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
10651 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
10652 }
10653 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010654
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010655 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010656 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
10657 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
10658 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
10659 if (Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
10660 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
10661 Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
10662 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010663 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010664 Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000010665 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010666 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010667 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
10668 }
10669
10670 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010671 Value *Idx[2];
10672 Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10673 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010674 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010675 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010676 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
10677 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
10678 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000010679 }
10680 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010681 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010682 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000010683
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000010684 /// See if we can simplify:
10685 /// X = bitcast A to B*
10686 /// Y = gep X, <...constant indices...>
10687 /// into a gep of the original struct. This is important for SROA and alias
10688 /// analysis of unions. If "A" is also a bitcast, wait for A/X to be merged.
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000010689 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000010690 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) && GEP.hasAllConstantIndices()) {
10691 // Determine how much the GEP moves the pointer. We are guaranteed to get
10692 // a constant back from EmitGEPOffset.
10693 ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(&GEP, GEP, *this));
10694 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
10695
10696 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, just replace the GEP
10697 // with a bitcast of the real input to the dest type.
10698 if (Offset == 0) {
10699 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
10700 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
10701 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
10702 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
10703 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
10704 if (I != BCI) {
10705 I->takeName(BCI);
10706 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
10707 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
10708 }
10709 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000010710 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000010711 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000010712 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000010713 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000010714
10715 // Otherwise, if the offset is non-zero, we need to find out if there is a
10716 // field at Offset in 'A's type. If so, we can pull the cast through the
10717 // GEP.
10718 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
10719 const Type *InTy =
10720 cast<PointerType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
10721 if (FindElementAtOffset(InTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD)) {
10722 Instruction *NGEP =
10723 GetElementPtrInst::Create(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
10724 NewIndices.end());
10725 if (NGEP->getType() == GEP.getType()) return NGEP;
10726 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, GEP);
10727 NGEP->takeName(&GEP);
10728 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, GEP.getType());
10729 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000010730 }
10731 }
10732
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000010733 return 0;
10734}
10735
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010736Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
10737 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010738 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000010739 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10740 const Type *NewTy =
10741 ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010742 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010743
10744 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
10745 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010746 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010747 else {
10748 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Nate Begeman14b05292005-11-05 09:21:28 +000010749 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000010750 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010751
10752 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010753
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010754 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
10755 // allocas if possible...
10756 //
10757 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
10758 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It)) ++It;
10759
10760 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
10761 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
10762 //
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010763 Value *NullIdx = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000010764 Value *Idx[2];
10765 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
10766 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010767 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
10768 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010769
10770 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
10771 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010772 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010773 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
10774 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010775 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010776 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010777
10778 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
10779 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate and
10780 // return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010781 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized() &&
Duncan Sandsceb4d1a2009-01-12 20:38:59 +000010782 TD->getTypePaddedSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000010783 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
10784
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000010785 return 0;
10786}
10787
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010788Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
10789 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
10790
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010791 // free undef -> unreachable.
10792 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
10793 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +000010794 new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(),
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000010795 UndefValue::get(PointerType::getUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010796 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10797 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010798
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010799 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
10800 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010801 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010802 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000010803
10804 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
10805 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
10806 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
10807 return &FI;
10808 }
10809
10810 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
10811 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10812 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
10813 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
10814 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
10815 return &FI;
10816 }
10817 }
10818
10819 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
10820 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
10821 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
10822 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
10823 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
10824 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000010825
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000010826 return 0;
10827}
10828
10829
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000010830/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010831static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010832 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010833 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010834 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010835
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010836 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
10837 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
10838 // directly if string length is small enough.
Evan Cheng0ff39b32008-06-30 07:31:25 +000010839 std::string Str;
10840 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010841 unsigned len = Str.length();
10842 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
10843 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
10844 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
10845 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000010846 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
10847 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
10848 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
10849 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
10850 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10851 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10852 }
10853 } else {
10854 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
10855 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i];
10856 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10857 }
10858 // Append NULL at the end.
10859 SingleChar = 0;
10860 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
10861 }
10862 Value *NL = ConstantInt::get(StrVal);
10863 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010864 }
10865 }
10866 }
10867
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010868 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010869 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010870 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010871
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010872 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010873 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010874 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
10875 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
10876 // constants.
10877 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
10878 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
10879 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000010880 Value *Idxs[2];
10881 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
10882 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010883 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
10884 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
10885 }
10886
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010887 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000010888 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000010889 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
10890 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
10891 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000010892 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
10893 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010894
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010895 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
10896 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
10897 // the result of the loaded value.
10898 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
10899 CI->getName(),
10900 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
10901 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000010902 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000010903 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000010904 }
10905 }
10906 return 0;
10907}
10908
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010909/// isSafeToLoadUnconditionally - Return true if we know that executing a load
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010910/// from this value cannot trap. If it is not obviously safe to load from the
10911/// specified pointer, we do a quick local scan of the basic block containing
10912/// ScanFrom, to determine if the address is already accessed.
10913static bool isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(Value *V, Instruction *ScanFrom) {
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010914 // If it is an alloca it is always safe to load from.
10915 if (isa<AllocaInst>(V)) return true;
10916
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010917 // If it is a global variable it is mostly safe to load from.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010918 if (const GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(V))
Duncan Sands46318cd2007-09-19 10:25:38 +000010919 // Don't try to evaluate aliases. External weak GV can be null.
Duncan Sands892c7e42007-09-19 10:10:31 +000010920 return !isa<GlobalAlias>(GV) && !GV->hasExternalWeakLinkage();
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010921
10922 // Otherwise, be a little bit agressive by scanning the local block where we
10923 // want to check to see if the pointer is already being loaded or stored
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010924 // from/to. If so, the previous load or store would have already trapped,
10925 // so there is no harm doing an extra load (also, CSE will later eliminate
10926 // the load entirely).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010927 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = ScanFrom, E = ScanFrom->getParent()->begin();
10928
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010929 while (BBI != E) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010930 --BBI;
10931
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010932 // If we see a free or a call (which might do a free) the pointer could be
10933 // marked invalid.
10934 if (isa<FreeInst>(BBI) || isa<CallInst>(BBI))
10935 return false;
10936
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010937 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
10938 if (LI->getOperand(0) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010939 } else if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010940 if (SI->getOperand(1) == V) return true;
Chris Lattner2de3fec2008-06-20 05:12:56 +000010941 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010942
Alkis Evlogimenos7b6ec602004-09-20 06:42:58 +000010943 }
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000010944 return false;
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000010945}
10946
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010947Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
10948 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000010949
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010950 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000010951 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op);
10952 if (KnownAlign >
10953 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
10954 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000010955 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
10956
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010957 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000010958 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000010959 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010960 return Res;
10961
10962 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
10963 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000010964
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000010965 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
10966 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
10967 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
10968 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000010969 if (Value *AvailableVal = FindAvailableLoadedValue(Op, LI.getParent(), BBI,6))
10970 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, AvailableVal);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010971
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010972 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
10973 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
10974 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10975 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
10976 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010977 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
10978 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
10979 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
10980 // CFG.
10981 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10982 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
10983 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
10984 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010985 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010986
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010987 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010988 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000010989 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
10990 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
10991 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010992 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
10993 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
10994 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000010995 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
10996 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010997 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010998 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000010999
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011000 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
11001 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000011002 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011003 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011004
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011005 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011006 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011007 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
11008 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000011009 if (GV->isConstant() && !GV->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000011010 if (Constant *V =
11011 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011013 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
11014 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11015 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11016 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11017 // CFG.
11018 new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
11019 Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
11020 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
11021 }
11022
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011023 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011024 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011025 return Res;
11026 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011027 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011028 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011029
11030 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
11031 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000011032 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011033 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasInitializer()) {
11034 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
11035 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Constant::getNullValue(LI.getType()));
11036 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
11037 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
11038 }
11039 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000011040
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011041 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011042 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
11043 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
11044 // exposes redundancy in the code.
11045 //
11046 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
11047 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
11048 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
11049 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
11050 // unconditionally.
11051 //
11052 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
11053 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000011054 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
11055 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011056 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000011057 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011058 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000011059 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011060 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011061 }
11062
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000011063 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
11064 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
11065 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11066 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
11067 return &LI;
11068 }
11069
11070 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
11071 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
11072 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11073 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
11074 return &LI;
11075 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011076 }
11077 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011078 return 0;
11079}
11080
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000011081/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011082/// when possible.
11083static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
11084 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
11085 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
11086
11087 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
11088 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
11089 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
11090
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000011091 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011092 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11093 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11094 // constants.
11095 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
11096 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
11097 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011098 Value* Idxs[2];
11099 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
11100 CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011101 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11102 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
11103 }
11104
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000011105 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy)) &&
11106 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
11107 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011108
11109 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000011110 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
11111 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011112 Value *NewCast;
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000011113 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000011114 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
11115 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
11116 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
11117 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11118 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000011119 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
Reid Spencer67f827c2007-01-20 23:35:48 +000011120 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +000011121 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000011122 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
11123 }
11124 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000011125 NewCast = ConstantExpr::getCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011126 else
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011127 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011128 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
Reid Spencer75153962007-01-18 18:54:33 +000011129 SI);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011130 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
11131 }
11132 }
11133 }
11134 return 0;
11135}
11136
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011137/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
11138/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
11139/// value in code like this:
11140/// %t0 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
11141/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
11142/// %t1 = getelementptr @a, 0, 3
11143/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
11144///
11145static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
11146 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
11147 if (A == B) return true;
11148
11149 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
11150 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
11151 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
11152 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
11153 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
11154 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
11155 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalTo(BI))
11156 return true;
11157
11158 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
11159 return false;
11160}
11161
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011162Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
11163 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
11164 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
11165
11166 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011167 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011168 ++NumCombined;
11169 return 0;
11170 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011171
11172 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
11173 // alloca dead.
Chris Lattnercea1fdd2008-04-29 04:58:38 +000011174 if (Ptr->hasOneUse() && !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011175 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
11176 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11177 ++NumCombined;
11178 return 0;
11179 }
11180
11181 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr))
11182 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) &&
11183 GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
11184 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11185 ++NumCombined;
11186 return 0;
11187 }
11188 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011189
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011190 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000011191 unsigned KnownAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr);
11192 if (KnownAlign >
11193 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
11194 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011195 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11196
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011197 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consequtive
11198 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
11199 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
11200 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
11201 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
11202 --ScanInsts) {
11203 --BBI;
11204
11205 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
11206 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011207 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() &&equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11208 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011209 ++NumDeadStore;
11210 ++BBI;
11211 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11212 continue;
11213 }
11214 break;
11215 }
11216
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011217 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11218 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11219 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11220 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011221 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11222 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011223 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11224 ++NumCombined;
11225 return 0;
11226 }
11227 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11228 // may not be dead.
11229 break;
11230 }
11231
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011232 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011233 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011234 break;
11235 }
11236
11237
11238 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011239
11240 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
11241 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr)) {
11242 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
11243 SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
11244 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011245 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011246 ++NumCombined;
11247 }
11248 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11249 }
11250
11251 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11252 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011253 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011254 ++NumCombined;
11255 return 0;
11256 }
11257
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011258 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11259 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011260 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011261 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11262 return Res;
11263 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011264 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011265 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11266 return Res;
11267
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011268
11269 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block, and if the block
11270 // ends with an unconditional branch, try to move it to the successor block.
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011271 BBI = &SI; ++BBI;
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011272 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011273 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11274 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11275 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011276
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011277 return 0;
11278}
11279
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011280/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11281/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11282/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11283///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011284/// Simplify things like:
11285/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11286/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11287///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011288bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11289 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11290
11291 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11292 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11293 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011294 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011295
11296 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11297 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011298 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11299 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011300 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011301 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011302 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011303 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011304 return false;
11305
11306 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011307 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011308 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011309 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011310 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011311 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011312 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011313
11314 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11315 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11316 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11317 return false;
11318
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011319 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11320 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011321 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011322 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011323 return false;
11324
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011325 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
11326 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
11327 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
11328 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
11329 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
11330 --BBI;
11331 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
11332 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11333 return false;
11334 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011335 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011336 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
11337 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
11338 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
11339 return false;
11340
11341 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000011342 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
11343 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011344 for (;; --BBI) {
11345 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
11346 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
11347 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
11348 return false;
11349 break;
11350 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011351 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
11352 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
11353 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011354 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
11355 return false;
11356 }
11357
11358 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011359 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
11360 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011361 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
11362 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000011363 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011364 return false;
11365 }
11366 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011367
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011368 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011369 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
11370 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011371 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011372 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
11373 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011374 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
11375 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011376 }
11377
11378 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
11379 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000011380 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011381 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
11382 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
11383
11384 // Nuke the old stores.
11385 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11386 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
11387 ++NumCombined;
11388 return true;
11389}
11390
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011391
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011392Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
11393 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000011394 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011395 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
11396 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
11397 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
11398 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
11399 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11400 BI.setCondition(X);
11401 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11402 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
11403 return &BI;
11404 }
11405
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011406 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
11407 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
11408 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11409 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11410 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
11411 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11412 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011413 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011414 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11415 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011416 // Swap Destinations and condition...
11417 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
11418 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11419 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011420 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011421 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011422 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011423 return &BI;
11424 }
11425
11426 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
11427 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
11428 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
11429 TrueDest, FalseDest)))
11430 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
11431 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
11432 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
11433 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011434 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011435 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(NewPred, X, Y, "", I);
11436 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011437 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000011438 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011439 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
11440 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011441 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000011442 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011443 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000011444 return &BI;
11445 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011446
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000011447 return 0;
11448}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011449
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011450Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
11451 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
11452 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
11453 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
11454 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
11455 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
11456 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011457 SI.setOperand(i,ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011458 AddRHS));
11459 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011460 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000011461 return &SI;
11462 }
11463 }
11464 return 0;
11465}
11466
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011467Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011468 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011469
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000011470 if (!EV.hasIndices())
11471 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
11472
11473 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
11474 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
11475 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
11476
11477 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
11478 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
11479
11480 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
11481 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
11482 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
11483 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
11484 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
11485 // first index
11486 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
11487 else
11488 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
11489 }
11490 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
11491 }
11492 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
11493 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
11494 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
11495 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
11496 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
11497 exti != exte && insi != inse;
11498 ++exti, ++insi) {
11499 if (*insi != *exti)
11500 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
11501 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
11502 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
11503 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
11504 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11505 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
11506 // with
11507 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
11508 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11509 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
11510 }
11511 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
11512 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
11513 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11514 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
11515 // with "i32 42"
11516 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
11517 if (exti == exte) {
11518 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
11519 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
11520 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
11521 // with
11522 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
11523 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
11524 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
11525 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
11526 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
11527 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
11528 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
11529 EV);
11530 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11531 insi, inse);
11532 }
11533 if (insi == inse)
11534 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
11535 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
11536 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
11537 // i.e., replace
11538 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
11539 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
11540 // with
11541 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
11542 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
11543 exti, exte);
11544 }
11545 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
11546 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
11547 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
11548 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000011549 return 0;
11550}
11551
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011552/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
11553/// is to leave as a vector operation.
11554static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
11555 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11556 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011557 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011558 if (isConstant) return true;
11559 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
11560 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
11561 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
11562 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
11563 return false;
11564 return true;
11565 }
11566 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
11567 if (!I) return false;
11568
11569 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
11570 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
11571 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
11572 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
11573 return true;
11574 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
11575 return true;
11576 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
11577 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
11578 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11579 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11580 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000011581 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
11582 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
11583 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
11584 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
11585 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011586
11587 return false;
11588}
11589
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000011590/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
11591///
11592/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
11593/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011594static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
11595 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
11596 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11597 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
11598 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
11599 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
11600
11601 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011602 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011603 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
11604 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011605 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
11606 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011607 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011608 return Result;
11609}
11610
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011611/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
11612/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
11613/// extracted from the vector.
11614static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011615 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
11616 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011617 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
11618 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011619 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11620
11621 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
11622 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
11623 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
11624 return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011625 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011626 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
11627 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11628 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011629 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
11630 return 0;
11631 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011632
11633 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
11634 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011635 if (EltNo == IIElt)
11636 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011637
11638 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
11639 // vector input.
11640 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011641 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011642 unsigned LHSWidth =
11643 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011644 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011645 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011646 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011647 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
11648 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011649 else
11650 return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011651 }
11652
11653 // Otherwise, we don't know.
11654 return 0;
11655}
11656
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011657Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011658 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011659 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11660 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11661
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000011662 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000011663 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
11664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
11665
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011666 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000011667 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
11668 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
11669 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011670 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011671 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011672 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
11673 op0 = 0;
11674 break;
11675 }
11676 if (op0)
11677 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011678 }
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011679
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011680 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
11681 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011682 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011683 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
11684 unsigned VectorWidth =
11685 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11686
11687 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
11688 // crashing the code below.
11689 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
11690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
11691
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011692 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
11693 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
11694 // property.
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000011695 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011696 uint64_t UndefElts;
11697 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011698 1 << IndexVal,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011699 UndefElts)) {
11700 EI.setOperand(0, V);
11701 return &EI;
11702 }
11703 }
11704
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011705 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011706 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000011707
11708 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
11709 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
11710 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
11711 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
11712 if (const VectorType *VT =
11713 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
11714 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
11715 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
11716 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
11717 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000011718 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000011719
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011720 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011721 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
11722 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
11723 // profitable to do so
11724 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011725 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
11726 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
11727 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
11728 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
11729 EI.getName()+".lhs");
11730 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
11731 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
11732 EI.getName()+".rhs");
11733 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
11734 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011735 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000011736 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011737 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000011738 unsigned AS =
11739 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000011740 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
11741 PointerType::get(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000011742 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
11743 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011744 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
11745 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011746 }
11747 }
11748 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
11749 // Extracting the inserted element?
11750 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
11751 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
11752 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
11753 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
11754 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
11755 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11756 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
11757 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
11758 return &EI;
11759 }
11760 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
11761 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
11762 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011763 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
11764 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011765 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011766 unsigned LHSWidth =
11767 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
11768
11769 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011770 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011771 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
11772 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011773 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
11774 } else {
11775 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000011776 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011777 return new ExtractElementInst(Src, SrcIdx);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011778 }
11779 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000011780 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000011781 return 0;
11782}
11783
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011784/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
11785/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
11786/// Otherwise, return false.
11787static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
11788 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
11789 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
11790 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011791 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011792
11793 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011794 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011795 return true;
11796 } else if (V == LHS) {
11797 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011798 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011799 return true;
11800 } else if (V == RHS) {
11801 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011802 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011803 return true;
11804 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11805 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11806 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11807 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11808 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11809
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011810 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
11811 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011812 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011813
11814 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
11815 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11816 // transitively ok.
11817 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11818 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011819 Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000011820 return true;
11821 }
11822 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
11823 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011824 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11825 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011826 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011827
11828 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
11829 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
11830 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
11831 // transitively ok.
11832 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
11833 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
11834 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011835 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011836 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011837 } else {
11838 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011839 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011840 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011841
11842 }
11843 return true;
11844 }
11845 }
11846 }
11847 }
11848 }
11849 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
11850
11851 return false;
11852}
11853
11854/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
11855/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
11856/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011857static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011858 Value *&RHS) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011859 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011860 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011861 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011862 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011863
11864 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011865 Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011866 return V;
11867 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011868 Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011869 return V;
11870 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
11871 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
11872 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
11873 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
11874 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
11875
11876 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11877 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11878 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
11879 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011880 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
11881 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011882
11883 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
11884 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011885 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
11886 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
11887 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000011888 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011889 ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011890 return V;
11891 }
11892
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011893 if (VecOp == RHS) {
11894 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011895 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
11896 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
11897 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011898 Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011899 }
11900 return V;
11901 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011902
11903 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
11904 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
11905 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
11906 return EI->getOperand(0);
11907
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011908 }
11909 }
11910 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011911 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011912
11913 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
11914 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011915 Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011916 return V;
11917}
11918
11919Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
11920 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
11921 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
11922 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
11923
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000011924 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
11925 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
11926 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11927
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011928 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
11929 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
11930 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
11931 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
11932 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
11933 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000011934 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
11935 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011936 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011937
11938 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
11939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11940
11941 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
11942 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
11943
11944 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
11945 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
11946 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
11947 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
11948
11949 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
11950 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
11951 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
11952 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
11953 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
11954 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
11955 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
11956 // Build a new shuffle mask.
11957 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
11958 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011959 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011960 else {
11961 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011962 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011963 NumVectorElts));
11964 }
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000011965 Mask[InsertedIdx] = ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011966 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011967 ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011968 }
11969
11970 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
11971 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
11972 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
11973 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000011974 Value *RHS = 0;
11975 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
11976 if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
11977 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011978 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, ConstantVector::get(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000011979 }
11980 }
11981 }
11982
11983 return 0;
11984}
11985
11986
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011987Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
11988 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
11989 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011990 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011991
11992 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000011993
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000011994 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000011995 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000011996 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000011997
11998 uint64_t UndefElts;
11999 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012000
12001 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
12002 return 0;
12003
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012004 uint64_t AllOnesEltMask = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth);
12005 if (VWidth <= 64 &&
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012006 SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
12007 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12008 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012009 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012010 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012011
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012012 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
12013 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
12014 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
12015 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012016 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
12017 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12018 }
12019
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012020 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
12021 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12022 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012023 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000012024 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012025 else {
12026 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012027 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012028 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012029 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
12030 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012031 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012032 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
12033 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012034 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012035 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012036 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012037 SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012038 SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012039 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12040 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012041 MadeChange = true;
12042 }
12043
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012044 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012045 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012046
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012047 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
12048 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
12049 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
12050 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
12051
12052 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
12053 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012054 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012055
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012056 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
12057 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12058 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012059
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012060 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
12061 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
12062 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
12063 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
12064 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
12065 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
12066 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
12067 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
12068 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
12069 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
12070 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
12071 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
12072
12073 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
12074 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
12075 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
12076 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
12077 else
12078 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
12079
12080 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
12081 // the replacement.
12082 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
12083 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12084 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
12085 if (NewMask[i] >= e*2) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000012086 Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012087 } else {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000012088 Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012089 }
12090 }
12091 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
12092 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012093 ConstantVector::get(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012094 }
12095 }
12096 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000012097
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012098 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
12099}
12100
12101
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012102
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012103
12104/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
12105/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
12106/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
12107/// end of its block.
12108static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
12109 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
12110
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000012111 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000012112 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayWriteToMemory() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
12113 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012114
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012115 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000012116 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
12117 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012118 return false;
12119
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012120 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
12121 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000012122 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
12123 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012124 Scan != E; ++Scan)
12125 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
12126 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012127 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012128
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000012129 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012130
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000012131 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012132 ++NumSunkInst;
12133 return true;
12134}
12135
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012136
12137/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
12138/// all reachable code to the worklist.
12139///
12140/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
12141/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
12142/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
12143/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
12144/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
12145///
12146static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012147 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012148 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012149 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000012150 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012151 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012152
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012153 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12154 BB = Worklist.back();
12155 Worklist.pop_back();
12156
12157 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
12158 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012159
12160 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Prev = NULL;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012161 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
12162 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012163
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012164 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
12165 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
12166 ++NumDeadInst;
12167 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
12168 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12169 continue;
12170 }
12171
12172 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
12173 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
12174 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
12175 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
12176 ++NumConstProp;
12177 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12178 continue;
12179 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000012180
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012181 // If there are two consecutive llvm.dbg.stoppoint calls then
12182 // it is likely that the optimizer deleted code in between these
12183 // two intrinsics.
12184 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Next = dyn_cast<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(Inst);
12185 if (DBI_Next) {
12186 if (DBI_Prev
12187 && DBI_Prev->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint
12188 && DBI_Next->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint) {
12189 IC.RemoveFromWorkList(DBI_Prev);
12190 DBI_Prev->eraseFromParent();
12191 }
12192 DBI_Prev = DBI_Next;
12193 }
12194
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012195 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012196 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012197
12198 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
12199 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
12200 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
12201 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
12202 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
12203 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012204 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012205 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012206 continue;
12207 }
12208 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
12209 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
12210 // See if this is an explicit destination.
12211 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12212 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012213 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012214 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012215 continue;
12216 }
12217
12218 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
12219 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
12220 continue;
12221 }
12222 }
12223
12224 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12225 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012226 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012227}
12228
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012229bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012230 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000012231 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012232
12233 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12234 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012235
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012236 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012237 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12238 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12239 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012240 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012241 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012242
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012243 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12244 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12245 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12246 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12247 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12248 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12249 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12250 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012251
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012252 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012253 ++NumDeadInst;
12254
12255 if (!I->use_empty())
12256 I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
12257 I->eraseFromParent();
12258 }
12259 }
12260 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012261
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012262 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12263 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
12264 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012265
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012266 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012267 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012268 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012269 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012270 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012271 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012272
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012273 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012274
12275 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012276 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012277 continue;
12278 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012279
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012280 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Chris Lattner0a19ffa2007-01-30 23:16:15 +000012281 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012282 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012283
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012284 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012285 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000012286 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
12287
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012288 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012289 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012290 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012291 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012292 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012293
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000012294 if (TD && I->getType()->getTypeID() == Type::VoidTyID) {
12295 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
12296 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i) {
12297 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i)) {
12298 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD))
12299 i->set(NewC);
12300 }
12301 }
12302 }
12303
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012304 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000012305 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012306 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
12307 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
12308 if (UserParent != BB) {
12309 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
12310 // See if the user is one of our successors.
12311 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
12312 if (*SI == UserParent) {
12313 UserIsSuccessor = true;
12314 break;
12315 }
12316
12317 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
12318 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
12319 // otherwise), we can keep going.
12320 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
12321 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
12322 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
12323 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
12324 }
12325 }
12326
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012327 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012328#ifndef NDEBUG
12329 std::string OrigI;
12330#endif
12331 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012332 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000012333 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012334 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012335 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012336 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
12337 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012338
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012339 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
12340 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
12341
12342 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012343 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012344 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012345
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012346 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
12347 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012348
12349 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
12350 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000012351 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
12352
12353 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
12354 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
12355 ++InsertPos;
12356
12357 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012358
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012359 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
12360 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012361 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000012362
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012363 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
12364 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012365 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012366
12367 // Erase the old instruction.
12368 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000012369 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012370#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000012371 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
12372 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000012373#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000012374
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012375 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
12376 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012377 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
12378 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
12379 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012380 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012381
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000012382 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012383 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012384 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012385 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000012386 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012387 AddToWorkList(I);
12388 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000012389 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000012390 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012391 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012392 }
12393 }
12394
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012395 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000012396
12397 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
12398 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012399 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012400}
12401
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012402
12403bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000012404 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
12405
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012406 bool EverMadeChange = false;
12407
12408 // Iterate while there is work to do.
12409 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000012410 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012411 EverMadeChange = true;
12412 return EverMadeChange;
12413}
12414
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000012415FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012416 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000012417}
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000012418
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +000012419